blob: f20b8b2ea09e3821ac25abab8bc812b8d58c3554 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau442e8342010-11-11 23:29:35 +01007 2010/11/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
510 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
511 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
512 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
513 writeable).
514
515 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516
517 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
518 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
519 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
520
521 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200522 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
523 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
524 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
525 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
526 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
527 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528
529 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
530
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100531log-send-hostname [<string>]
532 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
533 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
534 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
535 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
536 the logs.
537
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538nbproc <number>
539 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
540 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
541 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
542 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
543 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
544
545pidfile <pidfile>
546 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
547 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
548 starting the process. See also "daemon".
549
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200550stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200551 [level <level>]
552
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
554 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100555 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200556 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
557
558 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
559 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
560 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
561 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
562 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
563
564 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
565 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
566 counters).
567
568 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
569 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100570
571 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
572 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
573 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
574 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
575 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
576 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
577 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200578
579stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
580 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
581 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100582 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200583
584stats maxconn <connections>
585 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
586 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588uid <number>
589 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
590 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
591 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
592 one. See also "gid" and "user".
593
594ulimit-n <number>
595 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
596 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
597 option.
598
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100599unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
600 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
601
602 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
603 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
604 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
605 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
606 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
607 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
608 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
609 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
610 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
611 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
612
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613user <user name>
614 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
615 See also "uid" and "group".
616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200617node <name>
618 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
619
620 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
621 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
622 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
623 traffic.
624
625description <text>
626 Add a text that describes the instance.
627
628 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
629 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
630 "<" and ">" characters.
631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006333.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634-----------------------
635
636maxconn <number>
637 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
638 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
639 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
640 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
641
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100642maxpipes <number>
643 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
644 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
645 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
646 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
647 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
648 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
649
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650noepoll
651 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
652 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
653 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
654
655nokqueue
656 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
657 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
658 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
659
660nopoll
661 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
662 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100663 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200664 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
665 "nokqueue".
666
667nosepoll
668 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
669 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
670 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
671
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100672nosplice
673 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
674 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
675 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100676 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100677 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
678 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
679 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
680 "option splice-response".
681
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200682spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
683 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
684 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
685 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
686 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
687 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
688
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689tune.bufsize <number>
690 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
691 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
692 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
693 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
694 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
695 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
696 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
697 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
698
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200699tune.chksize <number>
700 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
701 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
702 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
703 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
704 checks whenever possible.
705
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100706tune.maxaccept <number>
707 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
708 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
709 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100710 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100711 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
712 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100713 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100714 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
715
716tune.maxpollevents <number>
717 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
718 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
719 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
720 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
721 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
722
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200723tune.maxrewrite <number>
724 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
725 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
726 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
727 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
728 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
729 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
730 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
731 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
732 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
733 bufsize.
734
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100735tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
736tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
737 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
738 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
739 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
740 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
741 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
742 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
743 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
744
745tune.sndbuf.client <number>
746tune.sndbuf.server <number>
747 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
748 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
749 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
750 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
751 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
752 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
753 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
754 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
755 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
756 notifying haproxy again.
757
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007593.3. Debugging
760--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200761
762debug
763 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
764 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
765 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
766 system startup.
767
768quiet
769 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
770 line argument "-q".
771
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007733.4. Userlists
774--------------
775It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
776http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
777it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
778
779userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100780 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100781 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
782
783group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100784 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100785 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
786 proceeded by "users" keyword.
787
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100788user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
789 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100790 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
791 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100792 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
793 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100794 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
795 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
796
797
798 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100799 userlist L1
800 group G1 users tiger,scott
801 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100802
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100803 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
804 user scott insecure-password elgato
805 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100806
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100807 userlist L2
808 group G1
809 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100810
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100811 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
812 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
813 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100814
815 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200817
8183.5. Peers
819--------------
820It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
821haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
822pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
823identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
824or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
825Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
826known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
827the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
828process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
829during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
830tables.
831
832peers <peersect>
833 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
834 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
835
836peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
837 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
838 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
839 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
840 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
841 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
842 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
843
844 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
845 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
846
847 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
848 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
849 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
850 across all peers.
851
852Example:
853 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100854 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
855 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
856 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200857
858 backend mybackend
859 mode tcp
860 balance roundrobin
861 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
862 stick on src
863
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100864 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
865 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200866
867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008684. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200869----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100870
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
872 - defaults <name>
873 - frontend <name>
874 - backend <name>
875 - listen <name>
876
877A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
878its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
879section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881
882A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
883connections.
884
885A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
886to forward incoming connections.
887
888A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
889parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100891All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
892'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
893case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
894
895Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
896logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
897proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
898However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
899name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
900
901Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
902and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
905modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
906arbitrary criteria.
907
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
910--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200912The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
913limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
914they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
915limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100916marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200917option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200918and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
919with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
920specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100921
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100923 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
924------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
925acl - X X X
926appsession - - X X
927backlog X X X -
928balance X - X X
929bind - X X -
930bind-process X X X X
931block - X X X
932capture cookie - X X -
933capture request header - X X -
934capture response header - X X -
935clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
936contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
937cookie X - X X
938default-server X - X X
939default_backend X X X -
940description - X X X
941disabled X X X X
942dispatch - - X X
943enabled X X X X
944errorfile X X X X
945errorloc X X X X
946errorloc302 X X X X
947-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
948errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200949force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100950fullconn X - X X
951grace X X X X
952hash-type X - X X
953http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100954http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200955http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100956http-request - X X X
957id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200958ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100959log X X X X
960maxconn X X X -
961mode X X X X
962monitor fail - X X -
963monitor-net X X X -
964monitor-uri X X X -
965option abortonclose (*) X - X X
966option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
967option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
968option allbackups (*) X - X X
969option checkcache (*) X - X X
970option clitcpka (*) X X X -
971option contstats (*) X X X -
972option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
973option dontlognull (*) X X X -
974option forceclose (*) X X X X
975-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
976option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200977option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100978option http-server-close (*) X X X X
979option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
980option httpchk X - X X
981option httpclose (*) X X X X
982option httplog X X X X
983option http_proxy (*) X X X X
984option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200985option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100986option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
987option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
988option logasap (*) X X X -
989option mysql-check X - X X
990option nolinger (*) X X X X
991option originalto X X X X
992option persist (*) X - X X
993option redispatch (*) X - X X
994option smtpchk X - X X
995option socket-stats (*) X X X -
996option splice-auto (*) X X X X
997option splice-request (*) X X X X
998option splice-response (*) X X X X
999option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1000option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1001-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1002option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1003option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1004option tcpka X X X X
1005option tcplog X X X X
1006option transparent (*) X - X X
1007persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1008rate-limit sessions X X X -
1009redirect - X X X
1010redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1011redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1012reqadd - X X X
1013reqallow - X X X
1014reqdel - X X X
1015reqdeny - X X X
1016reqiallow - X X X
1017reqidel - X X X
1018reqideny - X X X
1019reqipass - X X X
1020reqirep - X X X
1021reqisetbe - X X X
1022reqitarpit - X X X
1023reqpass - X X X
1024reqrep - X X X
1025-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1026reqsetbe - X X X
1027reqtarpit - X X X
1028retries X - X X
1029rspadd - X X X
1030rspdel - X X X
1031rspdeny - X X X
1032rspidel - X X X
1033rspideny - X X X
1034rspirep - X X X
1035rsprep - X X X
1036server - - X X
1037source X - X X
1038srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001039stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001040stats auth X - X X
1041stats enable X - X X
1042stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001043stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001044stats realm X - X X
1045stats refresh X - X X
1046stats scope X - X X
1047stats show-desc X - X X
1048stats show-legends X - X X
1049stats show-node X - X X
1050stats uri X - X X
1051-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1052stick match - - X X
1053stick on - - X X
1054stick store-request - - X X
1055stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001056tcp-request connection - X X -
1057tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001058tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001059tcp-response content - - X X
1060tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001061timeout check X - X X
1062timeout client X X X -
1063timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1064timeout connect X - X X
1065timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1066timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1067timeout http-request X X X X
1068timeout queue X - X X
1069timeout server X - X X
1070timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1071timeout tarpit X X X X
1072transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1073use_backend - X X -
1074------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1075 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1079---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001080
1081This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1082
1083
1084acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1085 Declare or complete an access list.
1086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1087 no | yes | yes | yes
1088 Example:
1089 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1090 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1091 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001093 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001094
1095
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001096appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1097 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1100 no | no | yes | yes
1101 Arguments :
1102 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1103 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1104
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001105 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001106 checked in each cookie value.
1107
1108 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1109 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1110 milliseconds.
1111
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001112 request-learn
1113 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1114 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1115 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1116 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1117 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1118 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1119
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001120 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1121 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1122 data following this prefix.
1123
1124 Example :
1125 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1126
1127 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1128 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1129
1130 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1131 2 modes are currently supported :
1132 - path-parameters :
1133 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1134 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1135 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1136 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1137 - query-string :
1138 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1139 query string.
1140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001141 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1142 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1143 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1144 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001145 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1146 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1147 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1149 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1150
1151 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1152
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001153 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1154 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1155 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001157 Example :
1158 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1159
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001160 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1161 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001162
1163
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001164backlog <conns>
1165 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1167 yes | yes | yes | no
1168 Arguments :
1169 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1170 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1171 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1172
1173 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1174 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1175 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1176 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1177 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1178 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1179 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1180 backlog parameter.
1181
1182 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1183 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1184 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1185
1186 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1187
1188
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001190balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1193 yes | no | yes | yes
1194 Arguments :
1195 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1196 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1197 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1198 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1199
1200 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1201 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1202 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1203 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001204 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1205 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1206 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1207 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1208 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1209 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1210 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1211 it, so that you don't worry.
1212
1213 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1214 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1215 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1216 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1217 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1218 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1219 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1220 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001221
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001222 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1223 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1224 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1225 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1226 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1227 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1228 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1229 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001231 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1232 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1233 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1234 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1235 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1236 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1237 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1238 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001239 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001241 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1242 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1243 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001244
1245 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1246 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1247 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1248 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1249 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1250 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1251 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001252 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1253 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1254 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001255
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001256 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1257 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1258 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1259 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1260 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1261 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1262 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1263 URIs start with a leading "/".
1264
1265 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1266 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1267 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1268 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001271 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1272
1273 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1274 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1275 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1276 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1277 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1278 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1279 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1280 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1281 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1282 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1283 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1284 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1285 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1286 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1287 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1288 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1289 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1290 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1291 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1292 be randomly balanced if at all.
1293
1294 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1295 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1296 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1297 server will receive the request.
1298
1299 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1300 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1301 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1302 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1303 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001304 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1305 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1306 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001307
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001308 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1309 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1310 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001311 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001312 algorithm is applied instead.
1313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001314 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001315 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1316 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1317 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1318
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001319 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1320 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1321 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1322
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001323 rdp-cookie
1324 rdp-cookie(name)
1325 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1326 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1327 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1328 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1329 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1330 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001331 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001332 used instead.
1333
1334 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1335 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1336 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1337 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1338
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001339 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1340 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1341 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001343 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001344 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1345 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001346
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001347 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001348 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001349
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001350 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1351 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1352 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353
1354 Examples :
1355 balance roundrobin
1356 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001357 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001358 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1359 balance hdr(host)
1360 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001361
1362 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1363 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001365 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001366 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1367 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1368 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1369 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1370
1371 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1372 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1373 defaults to 16 kB.
1374
1375 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1376 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1377
1378 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1379 Round Robin.
1380
1381 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1382 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1383 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1384 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1385
1386 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1387
1388 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001389 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001390 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1391 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1392 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001393
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001394 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1395 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001396
1397
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001398bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1399bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1400bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1401bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1402bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1403bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1404bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001405bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001406bind /<path> [, ...]
1407bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1408bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1409bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1412 no | yes | yes | no
1413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001414 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1415 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1416 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1417 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1418 special address "0.0.0.0".
1419
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001420 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1421 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001422 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1423 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1424 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001425 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1426 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1427 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1428 the range.
1429
1430 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1431 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1432 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1433 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1434 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1435 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1436 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1437 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1438 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001439
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001440 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1441 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1442 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1443 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1444 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1445 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1446 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1447 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1448
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001449 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1450 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1451 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1452 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1453 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1454 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1455 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1456 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001457 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1458 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001459
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001460 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1461 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1462 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1463 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1464 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1465 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1466 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1467 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001468 This parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001469
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001470 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1471 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1472 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1473 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001474
1475 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1476
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001477 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1478 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1479 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1480 simply ignore this.
1481
1482 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1483 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1484 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1485 simply ignore this.
1486
1487 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1488 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1489 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1490 this.
1491
1492 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1493 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1494 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1495 this.
1496
1497 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1498 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1499 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1500 this.
1501
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001502 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1503 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1504 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001505 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001506 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1507 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1508 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1509 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001510 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1511 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001512
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001513 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001514 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1515 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1516 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1517 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1518 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1519 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1520 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1521 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1522 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1523 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1524 with front firewalls which would see an established
1525 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1526
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001527 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1528 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1529 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1530 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1531 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1532 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1533 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1534 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1535 This keyword combined with support from external components
1536 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1537 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1538 not even always usable.
1539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1541 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1542 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1543 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1544 in a frontend.
1545
1546 Example :
1547 listen http_proxy
1548 bind :80,:443
1549 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001550 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001552 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001553 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001554
1555
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001556bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1557 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1559 yes | yes | yes | yes
1560 Arguments :
1561 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1562 may be used to override a default value.
1563
1564 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1565 option may be combined with other numbers.
1566
1567 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1568 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1569 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1570 missing from all processes.
1571
1572 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1573 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1574 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1575 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1576
1577 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1578 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1579 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1580 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1581 and 'even' instances.
1582
1583 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1584 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1585 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1586 32.
1587
1588 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1589 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1590
1591 Example :
1592 listen app_ip1
1593 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001594 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001595
1596 listen app_ip2
1597 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001598 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001599
1600 listen management
1601 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001602 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001603
1604 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1605
1606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607block { if | unless } <condition>
1608 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1610 no | yes | yes | yes
1611
1612 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1613 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001614 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1616 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1617 "block" statements per instance.
1618
1619 Example:
1620 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1621 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1622 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1623 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001625 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626
1627
1628capture cookie <name> len <length>
1629 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1631 no | yes | yes | no
1632 Arguments :
1633 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1634 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1635 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1636 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1637 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1638
1639 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1640 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1641 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1642 right if it exceeds <length>.
1643
1644 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1645 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1646 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1647 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1648
1649 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1650 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1651 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1652
1653 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1654 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1655 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1656 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001657 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001658 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1659
1660 Example:
1661 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1662
1663 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001664 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001665
1666
1667capture request header <name> len <length>
1668 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1670 no | yes | yes | no
1671 Arguments :
1672 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001673 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1675 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1676 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1677
1678 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1679 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1680 it exceeds <length>.
1681
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001682 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1684 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001685 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1686 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1687 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1688 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001689 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001690 environments to find where the request came from.
1691
1692 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1693 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1694 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1695 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001696
1697 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1698 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1699 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1700 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1701
1702 Example:
1703 capture request header Host len 15
1704 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1705 capture request header Referrer len 15
1706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001707 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708 about logging.
1709
1710
1711capture response header <name> len <length>
1712 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1714 no | yes | yes | no
1715 Arguments :
1716 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001717 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1719 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1720 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1721
1722 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1723 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1724 it exceeds <length>.
1725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001726 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1728 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1729 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001730 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1731 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1732 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1733 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734
1735 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1736 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1737 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1738 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1739
1740 Example:
1741 capture response header Content-length len 9
1742 capture response header Location len 15
1743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001744 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745 about logging.
1746
1747
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001748clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1751 yes | yes | yes | no
1752 Arguments :
1753 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1754 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1755 as explained at the top of this document.
1756
1757 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1758 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1759 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1760 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1761 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1762 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1763 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1764 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001765 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1767 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1768
1769 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1770 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1771 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1772 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1773 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1774 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1775
1776 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1777 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1778
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001779 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1780 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
1782
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001783contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 yes | no | yes | yes
1787 Arguments :
1788 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1789 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1790 as explained at the top of this document.
1791
1792 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001793 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001794 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1796 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1797 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1798 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1799
1800 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1801 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1802 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1803 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1804 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1805 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1806
1807 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1808 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1809 instead.
1810
1811 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1812 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1813
1814
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001815cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001816 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001817 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1820 yes | no | yes | yes
1821 Arguments :
1822 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1823 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1824 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1825 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1826 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1827 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1828 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1829 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1830 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1831
1832 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1833 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1834 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1835 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1836 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1837 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1838 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1839 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1840 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1841 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1842 "insert" and "prefix".
1843
1844 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001845 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001846
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001847 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001848 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1849 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1850 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1851 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1852 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1853 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1854 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1855 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1856 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1857 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858
1859 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1860 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1861 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1862 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1863 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1864 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1865 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1866 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1867 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1868 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1869 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1870
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001871 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1872 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1873 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001874 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1875 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1876 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1877 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
1879 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1880 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1881 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1882 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1883 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1884 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1885 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1886 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1887 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1888
1889 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1890 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1891 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1892 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1893 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1894 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1895 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1896 persistence cookie in the cache.
1897 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1898
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001899 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1900 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1901 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1902 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1903 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1904 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1905 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1906 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1907 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1908 they logout.
1909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001910 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001911 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001912 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1913 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1914 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1915 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1916 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1917 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001918
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001919 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1920 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1921 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1922 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1923 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1924 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1925 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1926 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1927 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1928 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1929 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1930 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1931 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1932 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1933 the site.
1934
1935 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1936 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1937 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1938 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1939 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1940 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1941 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1942 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1943 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1944 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1945 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1946 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1947 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1948 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1949 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1950 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1953 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1954 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1955 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957 Examples :
1958 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1959 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1960 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001961 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001963 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001964 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001967default-server [param*]
1968 Change default options for a server in a backend
1969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1970 yes | no | yes | yes
1971 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001972 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1973 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1974 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1975 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001976
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001977 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001978 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1979
1980 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983default_backend <backend>
1984 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1986 yes | yes | yes | no
1987 Arguments :
1988 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1989
1990 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1991 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1992 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1993 will catch all undetermined requests.
1994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001995 Example :
1996
1997 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1998 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1999 default_backend dynamic
2000
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002001 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
2004disabled
2005 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2007 yes | yes | yes | yes
2008 Arguments : none
2009
2010 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2011 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2012 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2013 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2014 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2015 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2016 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2017
2018 See also : "enabled"
2019
2020
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002021dispatch <address>:<port>
2022 Set a default server address
2023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2024 no | no | yes | yes
2025 Arguments : none
2026
2027 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2028 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2029 during start-up.
2030
2031 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2032 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2033 possible with normal servers.
2034
2035 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
2036 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2037 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2038 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2039 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2040
2041 See also : "server"
2042
2043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044enabled
2045 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2047 yes | yes | yes | yes
2048 Arguments : none
2049
2050 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2051 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2052
2053 See also : "disabled"
2054
2055
2056errorfile <code> <file>
2057 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2059 yes | yes | yes | yes
2060 Arguments :
2061 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2062 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2063
2064 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002065 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002067 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2068 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069
2070 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2071 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2072 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2073
2074 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2075 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2076 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2077 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2078
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002079 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2080 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2081 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2082 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2083 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2084 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2087 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2088 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002089 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2091
2092 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2093
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002094 Example :
2095 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2096 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2097 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2098
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002099
2100errorloc <code> <url>
2101errorloc302 <code> <url>
2102 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2104 yes | yes | yes | yes
2105 Arguments :
2106 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2107 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2108
2109 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2110 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2111 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2112 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2113 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2114
2115 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2116 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2117 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2118
2119 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2120 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2121 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2122 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2123 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2124 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2125 request.
2126
2127 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2128
2129
2130errorloc303 <code> <url>
2131 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2133 yes | yes | yes | yes
2134 Arguments :
2135 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2136 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2137
2138 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2139 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2140 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2141 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2142 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2143
2144 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2145 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2146 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2147
2148 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2149 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2150 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2151 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002152 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002153
2154 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2155
2156
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002157force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2158 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2159 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2160 no | yes | yes | yes
2161
2162 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2163 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2164 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2165 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2166 marked down for maintenance operations.
2167
2168 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2169 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2170 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2171 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2172 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2173 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2174 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2175 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2176 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2177
2178 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2179 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2180 is used.
2181
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002182 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002183 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002184
2185
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002186fullconn <conns>
2187 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2189 yes | no | yes | yes
2190 Arguments :
2191 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2192 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2193
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002194 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002195 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002196 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002197 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2198 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2199 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2200 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2201 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002202 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002203
2204 Example :
2205 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2206 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2207 # connections.
2208 backend dynamic
2209 fullconn 10000
2210 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2211 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2212
2213 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2214
2215
2216grace <time>
2217 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002219 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002220 Arguments :
2221 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2222 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2223 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2224
2225 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2226 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002227 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002228 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2229
2230 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2231 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2232 simplify it.
2233
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002235hash-type <method>
2236 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2238 yes | no | yes | yes
2239 Arguments :
2240 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2241 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2242 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2243 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2244 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2245 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2246 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2247 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2248 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2249
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002250 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2251 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2252 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2253 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2254 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2255 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2256 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2257 this value.
2258
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002259 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2260 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2261 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2262 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2263 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2264 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2265 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2266 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2267 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2268 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2269 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2270 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2271 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2272
2273 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2274
2275 See also : "balance", "server"
2276
2277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278http-check disable-on-404
2279 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002281 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282 Arguments : none
2283
2284 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2285 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2286 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2287 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2288 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2289 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2290 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2291 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002292 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2293 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2294 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2295
2296 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2297
2298
2299http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2300 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2302 no | no | yes | yes
2303 Arguments :
2304 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2305 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2306 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2307 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2308 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2309 details on the supported keywords.
2310
2311 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2312 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2313 with the usual backslash ('\').
2314
2315 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2316 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2317 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2318 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2319 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2320
2321 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2322 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2323 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2324 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2325 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2326
2327 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2328 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2329 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2330 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2331 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2332 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2333
2334 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2335 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2336 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2337 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2338 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2339 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2340 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2341 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2342 trace).
2343
2344 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2345 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2346 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2347 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2348 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2349 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2350 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2351 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2352
2353 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2354 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2355 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2356 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2357 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2358 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2359 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2360 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2361
2362 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2363 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2364
2365 Examples :
2366 # only accept status 200 as valid
2367 http-request expect status 200
2368
2369 # consider SQL errors as errors
2370 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2371
2372 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2373 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2374
2375 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2376 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002378 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002379
2380
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002381http-check send-state
2382 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2384 yes | no | yes | yes
2385 Arguments : none
2386
2387 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2388 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2389 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2390 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2391 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2392
2393 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2394 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2395 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2396 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2397 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2398 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2399 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2400 checked in multiple backends.
2401
2402 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2403 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2404
2405 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2406 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2407 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2408 one fails.
2409
2410 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2411 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2412 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2413
2414 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2415 server's queue.
2416
2417 Example of a header received by the application server :
2418 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2419 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2420
2421 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2422
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002423http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002425 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2426
2427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2428 no | yes | yes | yes
2429
2430 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2431 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2432 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002433 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2434 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002435 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2436
2437 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2438 instance.
2439
2440 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002441 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2442 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2443 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002444
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002445 http-request allow if nagios
2446 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2447 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2448 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002449
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002450 Example:
2451 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002452
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002453 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002454
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002455 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2456 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002458id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002459 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2461 no | yes | yes | yes
2462 Arguments : none
2463
2464 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2465 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2466 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002467
2468
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002469ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2470 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2472 no | yes | yes | yes
2473
2474 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2475 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2476 and running).
2477
2478 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2479 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2480 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2481 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2482 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2483
2484 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2485 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2486
2487 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2488 "unless" condition is met.
2489
2490 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2491
2492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002493log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002494log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002495 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 yes | yes | yes | yes
2498 Arguments :
2499 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2500 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2501 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2502 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2503 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2504 parameter.
2505
2506 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2507 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2508
2509 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2510 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2511 standard syslog port).
2512
2513 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2514 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2515 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2516 appropriately writeable).
2517
2518 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2519
2520 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2521 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2522 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2523
2524 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2525 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2526 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002527 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2528 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2529 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2530 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2531 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002532
2533 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2534
2535 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2536 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2537 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2538
2539 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002540 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2541 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2542 "info".
2543
2544 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2545 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2546 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2547 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2548
2549 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2550 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002551
2552 Example :
2553 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002554 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2555 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557
2558maxconn <conns>
2559 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2561 yes | yes | yes | no
2562 Arguments :
2563 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2564 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2565 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2566 closes.
2567
2568 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2569 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2570 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2571 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2572 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2573 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2574 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2575 properly tuned.
2576
2577 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2578 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2579 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2580
2581 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2582
2583
2584mode { tcp|http|health }
2585 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2587 yes | yes | yes | yes
2588 Arguments :
2589 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2590 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2591 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2592 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2593
2594 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2595 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2596 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2597 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2598 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2599
2600 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2601 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2602 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2603 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2604 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2605 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2606
2607 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2608 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2609 will be refused.
2610
2611 Example :
2612 defaults http_instances
2613 mode http
2614
2615 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002619 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2621 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002622 Arguments :
2623 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2624 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002625 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2627 backend and its backup.
2628
2629 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2630 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2631 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2632 servers in a list of backends.
2633
2634 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2635 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2636 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2637 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2638 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2639 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2640 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002641 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642
2643 Example:
2644 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002645 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2647 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2648 monitor-uri /site_alive
2649 monitor fail if site_dead
2650
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002651 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2652
2653
2654monitor-net <source>
2655 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2657 yes | yes | yes | no
2658 Arguments :
2659 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2660 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2661 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2662 followed by a mask.
2663
2664 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2665 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002666 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002667 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2668
2669 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2670 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2671 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2672 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2673 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2674
2675 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2676 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2677 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2678 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2679 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2680
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002681 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2682 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2683
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002684 Example :
2685 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2686 frontend www
2687 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2688
2689 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2690
2691
2692monitor-uri <uri>
2693 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 yes | yes | yes | no
2696 Arguments :
2697 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2698 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2699
2700 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2701 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2702 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2703 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2704 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2705 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2706 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2707 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2708
2709 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2710 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2711 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2712 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2713 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2714 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2715
2716 Example :
2717 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2718 frontend www
2719 mode http
2720 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2721
2722 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002725option abortonclose
2726no option abortonclose
2727 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2729 yes | no | yes | yes
2730 Arguments : none
2731
2732 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2733 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2734 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2735 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002736 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002737 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2738 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2739 encountered while delivering the response.
2740
2741 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2742 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2743 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2744 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2745 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2746 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002747 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002748 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002749 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002750 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2751 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2752 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2753
2754 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2755 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2756 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2757 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2758 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2759 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2760 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2761 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002762 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002763
2764 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2765 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2766
2767 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2768
2769
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002770option accept-invalid-http-request
2771no option accept-invalid-http-request
2772 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2774 yes | yes | yes | no
2775 Arguments : none
2776
2777 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2778 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2779 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2780 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2781 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2782 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2783 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2784 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2785 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2786
2787 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2788 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2789 been confirmed.
2790
2791 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2792 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2793 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2794 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2795
2796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2798
2799 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2800 stats socket.
2801
2802
2803option accept-invalid-http-response
2804no option accept-invalid-http-response
2805 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2807 yes | no | yes | yes
2808 Arguments : none
2809
2810 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2811 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2812 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2813 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2814 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2815 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2816 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2817 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2818 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2819
2820 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2821 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2822 been confirmed.
2823
2824 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2825 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2826 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2827 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2828
2829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2831
2832 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2833 stats socket.
2834
2835
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002836option allbackups
2837no option allbackups
2838 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2840 yes | no | yes | yes
2841 Arguments : none
2842
2843 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2844 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2845 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2846 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2847 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2848 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2849 order between the backup servers anymore.
2850
2851 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2852 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2853
2854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2856
2857
2858option checkcache
2859no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002860 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2862 yes | no | yes | yes
2863 Arguments : none
2864
2865 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2866 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002867 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002868 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2869 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2870 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2871
2872 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002873 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002874 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002875 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2876 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002877 to the client are :
2878 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002879 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002880 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002881 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2882 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2883 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2884 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2885 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2886 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2887 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2888 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2889 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2890 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2891 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2892
2893 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002894 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002895 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002896 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002897 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2898
2899 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2900 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002901 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002902 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2903
2904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2906
2907
2908option clitcpka
2909no option clitcpka
2910 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2912 yes | yes | yes | no
2913 Arguments : none
2914
2915 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2916 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2917 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2918 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2919
2920 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2921 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2922 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2923 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2924
2925 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2926 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2927 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2928 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2929 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2930
2931 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2932
2933 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2934 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2935 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2936
2937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2939
2940 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2941
2942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943option contstats
2944 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | no
2947 Arguments : none
2948
2949 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2950 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2951 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2952 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2953 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2954 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2955 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2956
2957
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002958option dontlog-normal
2959no option dontlog-normal
2960 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2962 yes | yes | yes | no
2963 Arguments : none
2964
2965 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2966 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2967 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2968 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2969 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2970 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2971 logged.
2972
2973 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2974 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2975 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002977 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002978 logging.
2979
2980
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002981option dontlognull
2982no option dontlognull
2983 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2985 yes | yes | yes | no
2986 Arguments : none
2987
2988 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2989 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2990 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2991 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2992 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2993 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2994 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2995
2996 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2997 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2998 would not be logged.
2999
3000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003003 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003004
3005
3006option forceclose
3007no option forceclose
3008 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003011 Arguments : none
3012
3013 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3014 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3015 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3016 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3017 global session times in the logs.
3018
3019 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003020 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003021 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3022 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3023 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3024 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003025
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003026 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3027 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3028 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3029
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3032
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003033 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003034
3035
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003036option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003037 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | yes | yes | yes
3040 Arguments :
3041 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3042 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003043 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003044 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003045
3046 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3047 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3048 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3049 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3050 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3051 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3052 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003053 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3054 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3055 possible that the client has already brought one.
3056
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003057 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003058 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003059 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3060 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003061 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3062 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003063
3064 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3065 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3066 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3067 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3068 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3069 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3070 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3071
3072 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003073 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3074 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3075 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003076
3077 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3078 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3079 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3080 when using this option.
3081
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003082 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003083 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3084 frontend www
3085 mode http
3086 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3087
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003088 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3089 backend www
3090 mode http
3091 option forwardfor header X-Client
3092
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003093 See also : "option httpclose"
3094
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003095
3096option http-pretend-keepalive
3097no option http-pretend-keepalive
3098 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 yes | yes | yes | yes
3101 Arguments : none
3102
3103 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3104 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3105 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3106 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3107 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3108 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3109 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3110 consider the response complete.
3111
3112 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3113 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3114 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3115 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3116 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3117 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3118
3119 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3120 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3121 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3122 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3123 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3124 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3125 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3126
3127 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3128 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003129 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3130 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3131 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003132
3133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3135
3136 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3137
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003138
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003139option http-server-close
3140no option http-server-close
3141 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3143 yes | yes | yes | yes
3144 Arguments : none
3145
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003146 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3147 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3148 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3149 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3150 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3151 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3152 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3153 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3154 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3155 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3156 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3157 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003158
3159 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3160 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3161 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3162 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003163 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3164 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003165
3166 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3167 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003168 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3169 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3170 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003171
3172 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3173 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3174
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003175 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3176 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003177
3178
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003179option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003180no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003181 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3183 yes | yes | yes | no
3184 Arguments : none
3185
3186 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3187 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3188 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3189 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3190 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3191 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3192 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3193
3194 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3195 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3196 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3197 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3198 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3199 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3200 request along its whole life.
3201
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003202 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3203 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3204 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3205 front of an existing proxy.
3206
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003207 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3208
3209 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3210 http-server-close".
3211
3212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003213option httpchk
3214option httpchk <uri>
3215option httpchk <method> <uri>
3216option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3217 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | no | yes | yes
3220 Arguments :
3221 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3222 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3223 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3224 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3225 ones.
3226
3227 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3228 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3229 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3230
3231 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3232 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3233 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3234 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3235 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3236
3237 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3238 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3239 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3240 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3241 the lack of any response.
3242
3243 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3244
3245 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3246 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3247 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3248
3249 Examples :
3250 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3251 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3252 backend https_relay
3253 mode tcp
3254 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3255 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3256
3257 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3258 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3259
3260
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003261option httpclose
3262no option httpclose
3263 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments : none
3267
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003268 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3269 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3270 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3271 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3272 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3273 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3274 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003275
3276 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003277 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3278 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3279 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3280 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3281 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3282 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003283
3284 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3285 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3286 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003287 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3288 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003289
3290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3292
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003293 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3294 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003295
3296
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003297option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003298 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003301 Arguments :
3302 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3303 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3304 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3305 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3306 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003307
3308 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3309 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3310 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3311 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3312 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3313 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3314 ports.
3315
3316 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3317
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3320 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3321 by default.
3322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003323 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003324
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003325
3326option http_proxy
3327no option http_proxy
3328 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3330 yes | yes | yes | yes
3331 Arguments : none
3332
3333 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3334 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3335 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3336 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3337 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3338
3339 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3340 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3341 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3342 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003343 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003344 be analyzed.
3345
3346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3348
3349 Example :
3350 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3351 backend direct_forward
3352 option httpclose
3353 option http_proxy
3354
3355 See also : "option httpclose"
3356
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003357
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003358option independant-streams
3359no option independant-streams
3360 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 yes | yes | yes | yes
3363 Arguments : none
3364
3365 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3366 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3367 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3368 receive data or not.
3369
3370 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3371 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3372 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3373 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3374 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3375 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3376 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3377 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3378 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3379 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3380 socket buffers.
3381
3382 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3383 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3384 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3385 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3386 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3387
3388 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3389
3390
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003391option ldap-check
3392 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3394 yes | no | yes | yes
3395 Arguments : none
3396
3397 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3398 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3399 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3400 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3401
3402 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3403 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3404
3405 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3406 configure it.
3407
3408 Example :
3409 option ldap-check
3410
3411 See also : "option httpchk"
3412
3413
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003414option log-health-checks
3415no option log-health-checks
3416 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3418 yes | no | yes | yes
3419 Arguments : none
3420
3421 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3422 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3423 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3424 of additional information is limited.
3425
3426 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3427 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3428
3429 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3430
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003431
3432option log-separate-errors
3433no option log-separate-errors
3434 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3436 yes | yes | yes | no
3437 Arguments : none
3438
3439 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3440 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3441 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3442 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3443 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3444 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3445 provides very important information.
3446
3447 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3448 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3449 error logs.
3450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003451 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003452 logging.
3453
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003454
3455option logasap
3456no option logasap
3457 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | yes | yes | no
3460 Arguments : none
3461
3462 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3463 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3464 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3465 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3466 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3467 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3468 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003469 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003470 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3471 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003473 Examples :
3474 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3475 mode http
3476 option httplog
3477 option logasap
3478 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3479
3480 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3481 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3482 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3483 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003485 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003486 logging.
3487
3488
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003489option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3490 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3492 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003493 Arguments :
3494 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3495 to MySQL server.
3496
3497 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3498 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3499 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3500 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3501 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3502 in the MySQL table, like this :
3503
3504 USE mysql;
3505 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3506 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3507
3508 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3509 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3510 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3511 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3512 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3513 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3514 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3515 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3516 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3517
3518 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3519 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003520
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003521 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003522
3523 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3524 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3525 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3526 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3527 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3528 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3529
3530 See also: "option httpchk"
3531
3532
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003533option nolinger
3534no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003535 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003538 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003539
3540 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3541 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3542 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3543 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3544 connections.
3545
3546 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3547 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3548 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3549 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3550 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3551 this too.
3552
3553 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3554 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3555 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3556
3557 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3558 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3559 for servers.
3560
3561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3563
3564
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003565option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3566 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | yes
3569 Arguments :
3570 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3571 matching <network>
3572 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3573 header name.
3574
3575 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3576 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3577 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3578 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3579 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3580 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3581 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3582 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3583 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3584 possible that the client has already brought one.
3585
3586 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3587 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3588 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3589 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3590 header and requires different one.
3591
3592 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3593 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3594 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3595 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3596 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3597 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3598 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3599
3600 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3601 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3602 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3603 both are defined.
3604
3605 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3606 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3607 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3608 when using this option.
3609
3610 Examples :
3611 # Original Destination address
3612 frontend www
3613 mode http
3614 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3615
3616 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3617 backend www
3618 mode http
3619 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3620
3621 See also : "option httpclose"
3622
3623
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003624option persist
3625no option persist
3626 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3628 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003629 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003630
3631 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3632 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3633 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3634 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3635 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3636 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3637 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3638 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3639 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3640 redirected to another valid server.
3641
3642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3644
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003645 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003646
3647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003648option redispatch
3649no option redispatch
3650 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3652 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003653 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003654
3655 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3656 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3657 be able to access the service anymore.
3658
3659 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3660 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3661
3662 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3663 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3664 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003666 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3667 "redisp" keywords.
3668
3669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3671
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003672 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003673
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003674
3675option smtpchk
3676option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3677 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003680 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003681 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3682 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3683 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3684
3685 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3686 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3687 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3688
3689 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3690 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3691 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3692 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3693 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3694 dead server.
3695
3696 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3697 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3698 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3699 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3700
3701 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3702 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3703 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3704 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3705 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3706
3707 Example :
3708 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3709
3710 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003713option socket-stats
3714no option socket-stats
3715
3716 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 yes | yes | yes | no
3719
3720 Arguments : none
3721
3722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003723option splice-auto
3724no option splice-auto
3725 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | yes
3728 Arguments : none
3729
3730 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3731 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3732 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3733 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003734 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003735 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3736 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3737 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3738 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3739
3740 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3741 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3742 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3743 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3744 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3745 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3746 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3747 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3748 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3749 keyword.
3750
3751 Example :
3752 option splice-auto
3753
3754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3756
3757 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3758 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3759
3760
3761option splice-request
3762no option splice-request
3763 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766 Arguments : none
3767
3768 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3769 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3770 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3771 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3772 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3773 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3774
3775 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3776
3777 Example :
3778 option splice-request
3779
3780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3782
3783 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3784 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3785
3786
3787option splice-response
3788no option splice-response
3789 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3791 yes | yes | yes | yes
3792 Arguments : none
3793
3794 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3795 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3796 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3797 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3798 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3799 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3800
3801 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3802
3803 Example :
3804 option splice-response
3805
3806 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3807 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3808
3809 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3810 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3811
3812
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003813option srvtcpka
3814no option srvtcpka
3815 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | no | yes | yes
3818 Arguments : none
3819
3820 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3821 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3822 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3823 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3824
3825 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3826 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3827 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3828 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3829
3830 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3831 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3832 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3833 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3834 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3835
3836 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3837
3838 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3839 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3840 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3841
3842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3844
3845 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3846
3847
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003848option ssl-hello-chk
3849 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | no | yes | yes
3852 Arguments : none
3853
3854 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3855 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3856 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3857 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3858 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3859 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3860 hello message.
3861
3862 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3863 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3864 messages, which is appreciable.
3865
3866 See also: "option httpchk"
3867
3868
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003869option tcp-smart-accept
3870no option tcp-smart-accept
3871 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3873 yes | yes | yes | no
3874 Arguments : none
3875
3876 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3877 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3878 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3879 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3880 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3881 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3882
3883 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3884 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3885 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3886 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3887
3888 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3889 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3890 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3891 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3892
3893 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3894 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3895 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3896
3897 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3898 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3899 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3900
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003901 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3902
3903
3904option tcp-smart-connect
3905no option tcp-smart-connect
3906 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | no | yes | yes
3909 Arguments : none
3910
3911 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3912 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3913 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3914 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3915 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3916
3917 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3918 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3919 complex.
3920
3921 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3922 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3923 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3924
3925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3927
3928 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3929
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003930
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003931option tcpka
3932 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935 Arguments : none
3936
3937 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3938 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3939 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3940 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3941
3942 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3943 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3944 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3945 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3946
3947 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3948 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3949 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3950 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3951 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3952
3953 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3954
3955 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3956 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3957 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3958 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3959 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3960 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3961 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3962 backends.
3963
3964 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3965
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003966
3967option tcplog
3968 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3970 yes | yes | yes | yes
3971 Arguments : none
3972
3973 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3974 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3975 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3976 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3977 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3978 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3979 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3980 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3981
3982 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003984 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003985
3986
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003987option transparent
3988no option transparent
3989 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003991 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003992 Arguments : none
3993
3994 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3995 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3996 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3997 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3998 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3999 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4000 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4001 appropriate server.
4002
4003 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4004 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4005
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004006 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
4007 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004009
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004010persist rdp-cookie
4011persist rdp-cookie(name)
4012 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | no | yes | yes
4015 Arguments :
4016 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004017 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4018 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004019
4020 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4021 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4022 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4023 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4024 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4025 forwarded to this server.
4026
4027 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4028 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4029 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004030 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004031 a single "listen" section.
4032
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004033 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4034 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4035 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4036
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004037 Example :
4038 listen tse-farm
4039 bind :3389
4040 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4041 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4042 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4043 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4044 persist rdp-cookie
4045 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4046 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4047 balance rdp-cookie
4048 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4049 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4050
4051 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4052
4053
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004054rate-limit sessions <rate>
4055 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4057 yes | yes | yes | no
4058 Arguments :
4059 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4060 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4061
4062 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4063 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4064 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4065 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4066 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4067 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4068
4069 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4070 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4071 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4072 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4073
4074 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4075 listen smtp
4076 mode tcp
4077 bind :25
4078 rate-limit sessions 10
4079 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4080
4081 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4082 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4083
4084 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4085
4086
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004087redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4088redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004089 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4091 no | yes | yes | yes
4092
4093 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004094 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004095
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004096 Arguments :
4097 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4098 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4099 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4100 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004101 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4102 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4103 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4104 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004105
4106 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4107 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4108 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4109 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4110 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4111 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4112 location with a GET method.
4113
4114 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4115 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4116
4117 - "drop-query"
4118 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4119 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4120 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4121 with a location-type redirect.
4122
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004123 - "append-slash"
4124 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4125 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4126 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4127 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4128
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004129 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4130 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4131 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4132 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4133 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4134 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4135 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4136
4137 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4138 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4139 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4140 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4141 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4142 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4143 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004144
4145 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4146 acl clear dst_port 80
4147 acl secure dst_port 8080
4148 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004149 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004150 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004151 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4152
4153 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004154 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4155 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4156 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004157 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004158
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004159 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4160 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4161 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004163 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004164
4165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004166redisp (deprecated)
4167redispatch (deprecated)
4168 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004171 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004172
4173 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4174 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4175 be able to access the service anymore.
4176
4177 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4178 redistribute them to a working server.
4179
4180 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4181 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4182 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004184 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4185 "option redispatch" instead.
4186
4187 See also : "option redispatch"
4188
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004189
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004190reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004191 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 no | yes | yes | yes
4194 Arguments :
4195 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4196 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004197 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004198
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004199 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4200 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4201
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004202 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4203 the last header of an HTTP request.
4204
4205 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4206 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4207 responses.
4208
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004209 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4210 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4211 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4212
4213 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4214 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004215
4216
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004217reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4218reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004219 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4221 no | yes | yes | yes
4222 Arguments :
4223 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4224 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4225 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4226 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4227 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4228 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4229 ignores case.
4230
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004231 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4232 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4233
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004234 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4235 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4236 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4237 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004238 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004239
4240 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4241 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4242
4243 Example :
4244 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4245 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4246 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4247
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004248 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4249 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004250
4251
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004252reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4253reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004254 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 no | yes | yes | yes
4257 Arguments :
4258 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4259 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4260 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4261 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4262 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4263 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4264
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004265 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4266 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4267
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004268 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4269 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4270 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4271 next servers.
4272
4273 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4274 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4275 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4276
4277 Example :
4278 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4279 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4280 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4281
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004282 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4283 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004284
4285
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004286reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4287reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004288 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 no | yes | yes | yes
4291 Arguments :
4292 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4293 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4294 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4295 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4296 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4297 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4298 case.
4299
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004300 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4301 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4302
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004303 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4304 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4305 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4306 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004307 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004308
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004309 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004310 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004311 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004312
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004313 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4314 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4315
4316 Example :
4317 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4318 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4319 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004321 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4322 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004323
4324
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004325reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4326reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004327 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4329 no | yes | yes | yes
4330 Arguments :
4331 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4332 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4333 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4334 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4335 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4336 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4337 case.
4338
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004339 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4340 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4341
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004342 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4343 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4344 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4345 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4346
4347 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4348 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4349
4350 Example :
4351 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4352 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4353 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4354 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004356 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4357 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004358
4359
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004360reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4361reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004362 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 no | yes | yes | yes
4365 Arguments :
4366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4367 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4368 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4369 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4370 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4371 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4372
4373 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4374 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4375 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4376 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004377 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004379 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4380 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4381
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004382 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4383 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4384 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4385
4386 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4387 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4388 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4389 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4390 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4391
4392 Example :
4393 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4394 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4395 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4396 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004398 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4399 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004400
4401
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004402reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4403reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004404 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4406 no | yes | yes | yes
4407 Arguments :
4408 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4409 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4410 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4411 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4412 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4413 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4414 ignores case.
4415
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004416 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4417 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4418
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004419 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4420 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004421 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4422 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4423 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004424 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4425 not set.
4426
4427 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4428 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4429 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4430 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4431 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004433 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004434 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4435 # block all others.
4436 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4437 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4438
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004439 # block bad guys
4440 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4441 reqitarpit . if badguys
4442
4443 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4444 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004445
4446
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004447retries <value>
4448 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4450 yes | no | yes | yes
4451 Arguments :
4452 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4453 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4454 default value is 3.
4455
4456 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4457 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4458 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4459
4460 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4461 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4462
4463 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4464 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4465
4466 See also : "option redispatch"
4467
4468
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004469rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004470 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 no | yes | yes | yes
4473 Arguments :
4474 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4475 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004476 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004477
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004478 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4479 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4480
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004481 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4482 the last header of an HTTP response.
4483
4484 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4485 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4486 responses.
4487
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004488 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4489 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004490
4491
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004492rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4493rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004494 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4496 no | yes | yes | yes
4497 Arguments :
4498 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4499 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4500 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4501 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4502 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4503 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4504 ignores case.
4505
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004506 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4507 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4508
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004509 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4510 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4511 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4512 client.
4513
4514 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4515 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4516 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4517
4518 Example :
4519 # remove the Server header from responses
4520 reqidel ^Server:.*
4521
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004522 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4523 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004524
4525
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004526rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4527rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004528 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 no | yes | yes | yes
4531 Arguments :
4532 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4533 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4534 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4535 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4536 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4537 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4538 ignores case.
4539
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004540 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4541 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4542
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004543 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4544 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4545 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4546 case-sensitive.
4547
4548 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004549 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4550 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4551 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552
4553 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4554 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4555
4556 Example :
4557 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4558 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4559
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004560 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4561 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562
4563
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004564rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4565rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004566 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 no | yes | yes | yes
4569 Arguments :
4570 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4571 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4572 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4573 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4574 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4575 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4576 ignores case.
4577
4578 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4579 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4580 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4581 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004582 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004584 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4585 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4586
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004587 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4588 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4589 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4590
4591 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4592 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4593 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4594 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4595 are not case-sensitive.
4596
4597 Example :
4598 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4599 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4600
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004601 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4602 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603
4604
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004605server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4606 Declare a server in a backend
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 no | no | yes | yes
4609 Arguments :
4610 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4611 appear in logs and alerts.
4612
4613 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4614 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004615 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4616 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4617 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4618 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4619 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4620 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4621 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4622 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004623
4624 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4625 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4626 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4627 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4628 adding this value to the client's port.
4629
4630 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4631 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004632 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004633
4634 Examples :
4635 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4636 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004638 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004639
4640
4641source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004642source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004643source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004644 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 yes | no | yes | yes
4647 Arguments :
4648 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4649 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4650 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4651 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4652
4653 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4654 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004655 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4656 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4657 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004658
4659 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4660 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4661 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4662 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4663 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4664 <addr>.
4665
4666 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4667 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4668 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4669 port.
4670
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004671 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4672 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4673 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4674 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4675 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4676 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4677 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4678 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4679 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4680 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4681 HTTP header.
4682
4683 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4684 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4685 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4686 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4687 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4688 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4689 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4690 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4691 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4692 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4693
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004694 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4695 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4696 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4697 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4698 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4699 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4700
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004701 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4702 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4703 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4704 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4705
4706 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4707 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4708 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4709 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4710 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4711 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4712
4713 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4714 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4715 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4716 there are two methods :
4717
4718 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4719 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4720 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4721 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4722 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4723 of the client ranges may be used.
4724
4725 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4726 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4727 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4728 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4729 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4730 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4731 same session.
4732
4733 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4734 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4735 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4736 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4737 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4738 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4739
4740 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4741 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4742 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004743 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004744
4745 Examples :
4746 backend private
4747 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4748 source 192.168.1.200
4749
4750 backend transparent_ssl1
4751 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4752 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4753
4754 backend transparent_ssl2
4755 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4756 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4757 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4758
4759 backend transparent_ssl3
4760 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4761 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4762 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4763
4764 backend transparent_smtp
4765 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4766 # with Tproxy version 4.
4767 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4768
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004769 backend transparent_http
4770 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4771 # proxy.
4772 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004774 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004775 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004777
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004778srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4779 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782 Arguments :
4783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4785 as explained at the top of this document.
4786
4787 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4788 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4789 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4790 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4791 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4792 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4793 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4794
4795 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4796 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4797 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4798 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4799 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004800 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004801 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004802 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004803
4804 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4805 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4806 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4807 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4808 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4809 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4810
4811 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4812 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4813
4814 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4815
4816
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004817stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4818 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4820 no | no | yes | yes
4821
4822 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4823 matched.
4824
4825 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4826 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4827
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004828 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4829 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4830 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4831
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004832 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4833
4834 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4835 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4836 to alter few servers at a time.
4837
4838 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4839
4840 Example :
4841 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4842 backend stats_localhost
4843 stats enable
4844 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4845
4846 Example :
4847 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4848 backend stats_auth
4849 stats enable
4850 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4851 stats admin if TRUE
4852
4853 Example :
4854 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4855 userlist stats-auth
4856 group admin users admin
4857 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4858 group readonly users haproxy
4859 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4860
4861 backend stats_auth
4862 stats enable
4863 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4864 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4865 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4866 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4867
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004868 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4869 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4870 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004871
4872
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004873stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4874 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 yes | no | yes | yes
4877 Arguments :
4878 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4879
4880 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4881
4882 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4883 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4884 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4885 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4886 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4887 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4888
4889 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4890 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4891 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4892 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4893
4894 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4895 report using "stats scope".
4896
4897 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4898 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4899 unobvious parameters.
4900
4901 Example :
4902 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4903 backend public_www
4904 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4905 stats enable
4906 stats hide-version
4907 stats scope .
4908 stats uri /admin?stats
4909 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4910 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4911 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4912
4913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4914 backend private_monitoring
4915 stats enable
4916 stats uri /admin?stats
4917 stats refresh 5s
4918
4919 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4920
4921
4922stats enable
4923 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4925 yes | no | yes | yes
4926 Arguments : none
4927
4928 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4929 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4930 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4931 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4932 - stats auth : no authentication
4933 - stats scope : no restriction
4934
4935 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4936 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4937 unobvious parameters.
4938
4939 Example :
4940 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4941 backend public_www
4942 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4943 stats enable
4944 stats hide-version
4945 stats scope .
4946 stats uri /admin?stats
4947 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4948 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4949 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4950
4951 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4952 backend private_monitoring
4953 stats enable
4954 stats uri /admin?stats
4955 stats refresh 5s
4956
4957 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4958
4959
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004960stats hide-version
4961 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004964 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004965
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004966 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4967 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4968 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4969 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4970 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4971 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004973 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4974 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4975 unobvious parameters.
4976
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004977 Example :
4978 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4979 backend public_www
4980 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004981 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004982 stats hide-version
4983 stats scope .
4984 stats uri /admin?stats
4985 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4986 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4987 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004988
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004989 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4990 backend private_monitoring
4991 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004992 stats uri /admin?stats
4993 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004994
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004995 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004996
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004997
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004998stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5000 Access control for statistics
5001
5002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5003 no | no | yes | yes
5004
5005 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5006 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5007 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5008 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5009 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5010 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5011
5012 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5013 instance.
5014
5015 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5016 about ACL usage.
5017
5018
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005019stats realm <realm>
5020 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | no | yes | yes
5023 Arguments :
5024 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5025 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5026 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5027
5028 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5029 using a backslash ('\').
5030
5031 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5032 only related to authentication.
5033
5034 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5035 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5036 unobvious parameters.
5037
5038 Example :
5039 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5040 backend public_www
5041 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5042 stats enable
5043 stats hide-version
5044 stats scope .
5045 stats uri /admin?stats
5046 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5047 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5048 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5049
5050 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5051 backend private_monitoring
5052 stats enable
5053 stats uri /admin?stats
5054 stats refresh 5s
5055
5056 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5057
5058
5059stats refresh <delay>
5060 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
5063 Arguments :
5064 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5065 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5066 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5067 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5068 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5069 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5070
5071 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5072 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5073 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5074 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5075
5076 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5077 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5078 unobvious parameters.
5079
5080 Example :
5081 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5082 backend public_www
5083 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5084 stats enable
5085 stats hide-version
5086 stats scope .
5087 stats uri /admin?stats
5088 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5089 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5090 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5091
5092 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5093 backend private_monitoring
5094 stats enable
5095 stats uri /admin?stats
5096 stats refresh 5s
5097
5098 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5099
5100
5101stats scope { <name> | "." }
5102 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 yes | no | yes | yes
5105 Arguments :
5106 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5107 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5108 section in which the statement appears.
5109
5110 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5111 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5112 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5113 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5114 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5115 exists.
5116
5117 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5118 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5119 unobvious parameters.
5120
5121 Example :
5122 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5123 backend public_www
5124 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5125 stats enable
5126 stats hide-version
5127 stats scope .
5128 stats uri /admin?stats
5129 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5130 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5131 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5132
5133 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5134 backend private_monitoring
5135 stats enable
5136 stats uri /admin?stats
5137 stats refresh 5s
5138
5139 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5140
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005141
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005142stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005143 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5145 yes | no | yes | yes
5146
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005147 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005148 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5149
5150 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5151 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5152
5153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5155 unobvious parameters.
5156
5157 Example :
5158 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5159 backend private_monitoring
5160 stats enable
5161 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5162 stats uri /admin?stats
5163 stats refresh 5s
5164
5165 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5166 global section.
5167
5168
5169stats show-legends
5170 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5171 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5172 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5173 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5174 - IP (socket, server)
5175 - cookie (backend, server)
5176
5177 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5178 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5179 unobvious parameters.
5180
5181 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5182
5183
5184stats show-node [ <name> ]
5185 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | no | yes | yes
5188 Arguments:
5189 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5190 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5191
5192 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5193 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5194 provided for each customer.
5195
5196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5198 unobvious parameters.
5199
5200 Example:
5201 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5202 backend private_monitoring
5203 stats enable
5204 stats show-node Europe-1
5205 stats uri /admin?stats
5206 stats refresh 5s
5207
5208 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5209 section.
5210
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005211
5212stats uri <prefix>
5213 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5215 yes | no | yes | yes
5216 Arguments :
5217 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5218 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5219 query string.
5220
5221 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5222 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5223 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5224 possible to reach it in the application.
5225
5226 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005227 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005228 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5229 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5230 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5231 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5232
5233 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5234 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5235 an address or a port to statistics only.
5236
5237 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5238 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5239 unobvious parameters.
5240
5241 Example :
5242 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5243 backend public_www
5244 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5245 stats enable
5246 stats hide-version
5247 stats scope .
5248 stats uri /admin?stats
5249 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5250 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5251 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5252
5253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5254 backend private_monitoring
5255 stats enable
5256 stats uri /admin?stats
5257 stats refresh 5s
5258
5259 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5260
5261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005262stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5263 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005265 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005266
5267 Arguments :
5268 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5269 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5270 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5271 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5272
5273 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5274 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5275 the "stick-table" statement.
5276
5277 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5278 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5279 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5280 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5281 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5282
5283 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5284 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5285 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5286 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5287 transformation rules.
5288
5289 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5290 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5291 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5292 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5293 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5294 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5295 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5296
5297 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5298 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5299 ACL based conditions.
5300
5301 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5302 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5303 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5304 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5305
5306 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5307 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5308 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5309 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5310
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005311 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5312 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5313 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005315 Example :
5316 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5317 # last 30 minutes
5318 backend pop
5319 mode tcp
5320 balance roundrobin
5321 stick store-request src
5322 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5323 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5324 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5325
5326 backend smtp
5327 mode tcp
5328 balance roundrobin
5329 stick match src table pop
5330 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5331 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5332
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005333 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5334 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005335
5336
5337stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5338 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5340 no | no | yes | yes
5341
5342 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5343 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5344 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5345 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5346
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005347 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5348 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5349 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5350
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005351 Examples :
5352 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005353 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005354
5355 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5356 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5357 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5358
5359
5360 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5361 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5362 backend http
5363 mode http
5364 balance roundrobin
5365 stick on src table https
5366 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5367 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5368 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5369
5370 backend https
5371 mode tcp
5372 balance roundrobin
5373 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5374 stick on src
5375 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5376 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5377
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005378 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005379
5380
5381stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5382 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 no | no | yes | yes
5385
5386 Arguments :
5387 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5388 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5389 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5390 server is selected.
5391
5392 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5393 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5394 the "stick-table" statement.
5395
5396 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5397 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5398 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5399 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5400 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5401 address.
5402
5403 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5404 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5405 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5406 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5407 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5408 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5409 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5410 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5411 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5412 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5413
5414 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5415 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5416 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5417 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5418 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5419 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5420 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5421
5422 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5423 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5424 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5425 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5426
5427 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5428 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5429 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5430 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5431 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5432 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5433 another protocol or access method.
5434
5435 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5436 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5437 the request.
5438
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005439 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5440 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5441 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5442
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005443 Example :
5444 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5445 # last 30 minutes
5446 backend pop
5447 mode tcp
5448 balance roundrobin
5449 stick store-request src
5450 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5451 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5452 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5453
5454 backend smtp
5455 mode tcp
5456 balance roundrobin
5457 stick match src table pop
5458 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5459 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5460
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005461 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5462 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005463
5464
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005465stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005466 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5467 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005468 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005470 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005471
5472 Arguments :
5473 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5474 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5475 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5476 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5477
5478 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5479 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5480 instance.
5481
5482 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5483 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5484 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5485 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5486 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5487 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005488 to 32 characters.
5489
5490 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5491 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5492 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5493 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5494 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5495 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005496
5497 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005498 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5499 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005500 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5501 increase.
5502
5503 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005504 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5505 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5506 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005507
5508 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5509 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5510 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5511 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5512 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5513 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5514 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5515 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5516 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5517 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5518 parameter (see below).
5519
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005520 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5521 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5522 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5523 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5524 soft restart.
5525
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005526 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5527
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005528 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5529 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5530 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5531 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5532 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5533 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5534 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5535 if not expiration delay is specified.
5536
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005537 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5538 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5539 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5540 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005541 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5542 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5543 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5544 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5545 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5546 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5547 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5548 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5549 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5550 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5551 types and their arguments.
5552
5553 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5554 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5555 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5556 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5557
5558 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5559 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5560 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5561 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5562
5563 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5564 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5565 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5566 they were received.
5567
5568 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5569 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5570 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5571 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5572 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5573
5574 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5575 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5576 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5577 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5578 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5579
5580 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5581 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5582 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5583
5584 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5585 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5586 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5587 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5588 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5589
5590 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5591 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5592 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5593 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5594 the client side.
5595
5596 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5597 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5598 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5599 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5600 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5601 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5602 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5603
5604 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5605 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5606 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5607 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5608 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5609 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5610 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5611
5612 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5613 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5614 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5615 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5616 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5617 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5618
5619 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5620 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5621 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5622 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5623
5624 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5625 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5626 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5627 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5628 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5629 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5630 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5631 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5632 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5633 recommended for better fairness.
5634
5635 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5636 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5637 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5638 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5639
5640 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5641 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5642 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5643 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5644 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5645 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5646 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5647 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5648 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5649 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005650
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005651 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5652 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005653 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5654 reference it.
5655
5656 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5657 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5658 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5659 as an exclusive stickiness.
5660
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005661 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5662 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5663 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5664 something that can be ignored.
5665
5666 Example:
5667 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5668 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5669 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5670 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5671
5672 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5673 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005674
5675
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005676stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5677 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 no | no | yes | yes
5680
5681 Arguments :
5682 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5683 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5684 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5685 server is selected.
5686
5687 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5688 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5689 the "stick-table" statement.
5690
5691 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5692 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5693 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5694 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5695
5696 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5697 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5698 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5699 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5700 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5701 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5702 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5703 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5704 rules.
5705
5706 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5707 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5708 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5709 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5710 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5711 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5712 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5713
5714 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5715 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5716 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5717 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5718
5719 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5720 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5721 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5722 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5723 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5724 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5725 another protocol or access method.
5726
5727 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5728
5729 Example :
5730 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5731 backend https
5732 mode tcp
5733 balance roundrobin
5734 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5735 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5736
5737 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5738 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5739
5740 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5741 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5742 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5743
5744 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5745 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5746
5747 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5748 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5749 # at offset 44.
5750
5751 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5752 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5753
5754 # Learn on response if server hello.
5755 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5756
5757 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5758 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5759
5760 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5761 extraction.
5762
5763
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005764tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5765 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005768 Arguments :
5769 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5770 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5771 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005772
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005773 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005774
5775 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5776 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005777 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5778 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5779 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5780 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5781 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5782 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005783
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005784 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5785 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5786 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5787 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005788
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005789 Three types of actions are supported :
5790 - accept :
5791 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5792 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5793 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005794
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005795 - reject :
5796 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5797 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5798 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5799 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5800 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5801 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5802 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5803 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5804 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5805 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5806 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5807 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005808
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005809 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5810 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5811 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5812 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5813 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5814 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5815 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5816 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5817 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005819 These actions take one or two arguments :
5820 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5821 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5822 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005824 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5825 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5826 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5827 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005828
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005829 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5830 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5831 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5832 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5833 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5834 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5835 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5836 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5837 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5838 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005840 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5841 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5842 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005844 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5845 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5846 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005848 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005849 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005850 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005851
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005852 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5853 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5854 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005856 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5857 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5858 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005859
5860 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5861
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005862 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005863
5864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005865tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5866 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005868 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005869 Arguments :
5870 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5871 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5872 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005874 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005876 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5877 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5878 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5879 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5880 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005882 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5883 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5884 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5885 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5886 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5887 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5888 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5889 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5890 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005892 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5893 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5894 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5895 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005896
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005897 Three types of actions are supported :
5898 - accept :
5899 - reject :
5900 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005902 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5903 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005905 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5906 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5907 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5908 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5909 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5910 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005912 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005913 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5914 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005916 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5917 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5918 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5919 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5920 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005921
5922 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005923 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5924 # and reject everything else.
5925 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5926 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5927 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5928 tcp-request content reject
5929
5930 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005931 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5932 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5933 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005934 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005935
5936 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5937 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5938 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005939 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005940 tcp-request content reject
5941
5942 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5943 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5944
5945 frontend http
5946 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5947 # protecting all our sites
5948 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5949 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5950 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5951 ...
5952 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5953
5954 backend http_dynamic
5955 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5956 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5957 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5958 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5959 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5960 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5961 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005963 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005964
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005965 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005966
5967
5968tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5969 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005971 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005972 Arguments :
5973 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5974 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5975 as explained at the top of this document.
5976
5977 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5978 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5979 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5980 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5981 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5982
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005983 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5984 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5985 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5986 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5987
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005988 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5989 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005990 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005991 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005992 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5993 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5994 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5995 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005996
5997 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5998 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5999 it pass through unaffected.
6000
6001 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6002 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6003 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006004 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006005 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6006 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006007 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6008 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6009 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006010
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006011 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006012 "timeout client".
6013
6014
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006015tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6016 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6018 no | no | yes | yes
6019 Arguments :
6020 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6021 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6022 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6023
6024 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6025
6026 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6027 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6028 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6029 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6030 set and expires with no matching rule.
6031
6032 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6033
6034 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6035 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6036 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6037 inserted.
6038
6039 Two types of actions are supported :
6040 - accept :
6041 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6042 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6043 the rules evaluation.
6044
6045 - reject :
6046 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6047 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6048 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6049
6050 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6051 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6052 for changing the default action to a reject.
6053
6054 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6055 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6056 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6057 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6058 period.
6059
6060 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6061
6062 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6063
6064
6065tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6066 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 no | no | yes | yes
6069 Arguments :
6070 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6071 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6072 as explained at the top of this document.
6073
6074 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6075
6076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006077timeout check <timeout>
6078 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6079 established.
6080
6081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083 Arguments:
6084 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6086 as explained at the top of this document.
6087
6088 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6089 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6090 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6091 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006092 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6093 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6094 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006095
6096 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6097 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6098
6099 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6100 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006101 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006102
6103 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6104 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6105 forget about it.
6106
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006107 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6108 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006109
6110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006111timeout client <timeout>
6112timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6113 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | yes | yes | no
6116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006117 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006118 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6119 as explained at the top of this document.
6120
6121 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6122 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6123 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6124 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6125 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6126 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6127 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6128 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006129 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006130 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6131 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6132
6133 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6134 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6135 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6136 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6137 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6138 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6139
6140 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6141 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6142 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6143
6144 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6145
6146
6147timeout connect <timeout>
6148timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6149 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6151 yes | no | yes | yes
6152 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006153 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6155 as explained at the top of this document.
6156
6157 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006158 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006159 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006160 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006161 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6162 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006163
6164 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6165 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6166 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6167 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6168 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6169 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6170
6171 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6172 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6173 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6174
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006175 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6176 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006177
6178
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006179timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6180 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6182 yes | yes | yes | yes
6183 Arguments :
6184 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6186 as explained at the top of this document.
6187
6188 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6189 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6190 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6191 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6192 once the request has started to present itself.
6193
6194 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6195 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6196 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6197 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6198 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6199
6200 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6201 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6202 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6203 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6204
6205 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6206 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6207 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6208 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6209 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006210 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006211
6212 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6213 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6214 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6215 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6216
6217 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6218
6219
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006220timeout http-request <timeout>
6221 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006224 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006225 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006226 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6227 as explained at the top of this document.
6228
6229 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6230 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6231 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6232 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6233 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6234 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6235 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6236 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6237
6238 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6239 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006240 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6241 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006242
6243 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6244 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6245 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6246 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6247 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6248
6249 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006250 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6251 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6252 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006253
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006254 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006255
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006256
6257timeout queue <timeout>
6258 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6260 yes | no | yes | yes
6261 Arguments :
6262 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6263 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6264 as explained at the top of this document.
6265
6266 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6267 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6268 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6269 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6270 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6271
6272 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6273 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6274 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6275 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6276
6277 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6278
6279
6280timeout server <timeout>
6281timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6282 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 yes | no | yes | yes
6285 Arguments :
6286 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6287 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6288 as explained at the top of this document.
6289
6290 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6291 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6292 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6293 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6294 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6295 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6296 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6297
6298 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6299 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6300 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6301 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6302 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006303 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006304 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006305 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006306
6307 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6308 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6309 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6310 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6311 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6312 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6313
6314 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6315 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6316 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6317
6318 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6319
6320
6321timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006322 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6324 yes | yes | yes | yes
6325 Arguments :
6326 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6328 as explained at the top of this document.
6329
6330 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6331 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6332 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6333
6334 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6335 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6336 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6337 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006338 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006339
6340 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6341
6342
6343transparent (deprecated)
6344 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006346 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006347 Arguments : none
6348
6349 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6350 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6351 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6352 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6353 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6354 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6355 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6356 appropriate server.
6357
6358 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6359
6360 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6361 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6362
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006363 See also: "option transparent"
6364
6365
6366use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6367use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006368 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6370 no | yes | yes | no
6371 Arguments :
6372 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006374 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006375
6376 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6377 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6378 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006379 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6380 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6381 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6382 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006383
6384 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6385 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6386 assign the backend.
6387
6388 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6389 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6390 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6391 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6392 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6393 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6394
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006395 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006396 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006397 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6398 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6399 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6400
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006401 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006402
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010064045. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006405------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006407The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6408which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6409arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6410settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6411after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6412Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6413address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006415 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006416 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006418The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006420addr <ipv4>
6421 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6422 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6423 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6424 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6425 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006427 Supported in default-server: No
6428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006429backup
6430 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6431 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6432 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6433 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6434 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6435 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006437 Supported in default-server: No
6438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006439check
6440 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6441 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6442 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6443 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6444 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6445 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6446 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6447 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6448 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006449 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6450 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006452 Supported in default-server: No
6453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006454cookie <value>
6455 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6456 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6457 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6458 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6459 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6460 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6461 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006463 Supported in default-server: No
6464
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006465disabled
6466 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6467 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6468 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6469 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6470 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6471
6472 Supported in default-server: No
6473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006474error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006475 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6476 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6477 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006479 Supported in default-server: Yes
6480
6481 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006483fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006484 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6485 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6486 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006488 Supported in default-server: Yes
6489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006490id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006491 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6492 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6493 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006495 Supported in default-server: No
6496
6497inter <delay>
6498fastinter <delay>
6499downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006500 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6501 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6502 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6503 between checks depending on the server state :
6504
6505 Server state | Interval used
6506 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6507 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6508 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6509 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6510 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6511 or yet unchecked. |
6512 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6513 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6514 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006516 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6517 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6518 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6519 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6520 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6521 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6522 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6523 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6524 servers.
6525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006526 Supported in default-server: Yes
6527
6528maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006529 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6530 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6531 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6532 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6533 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6534 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6535 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6536 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006538 Supported in default-server: Yes
6539
6540maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006541 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6542 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6543 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6544 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6545 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6546 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6547 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006549 Supported in default-server: Yes
6550
6551minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006552 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6553 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6554 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6555 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6556 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6557 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006558 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006559 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006561 Supported in default-server: Yes
6562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006563observe <mode>
6564 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6565 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6566 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6567 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6568 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6569 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6570 headers, a timeout, etc.
6571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006572 Supported in default-server: No
6573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006574 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6575
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006576on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006577 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6578 Currently, four modes are available:
6579 - fastinter: force fastinter
6580 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6581 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6582 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6583 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006585 Supported in default-server: Yes
6586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006587 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006589port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006590 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6591 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6592 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6593 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6594 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6595 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006597 Supported in default-server: Yes
6598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006599redir <prefix>
6600 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6601 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6602 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6603 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6604 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6605 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6606 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6607 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006608 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006609 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6610 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6611 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6612 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6613 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6614
6615 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006617 Supported in default-server: No
6618
6619rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006620 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6621 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6622 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006624 Supported in default-server: Yes
6625
6626slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006627 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6628 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6629 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6630 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6631 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6632 parameters :
6633
6634 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6635 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6636
6637 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6638 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6639 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6640 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6641
6642 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6643 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6644 seen as failed.
6645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006646 Supported in default-server: Yes
6647
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006648source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006649source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006650source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006651 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6652 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6653 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6654 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6655
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006656 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6657 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6658 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6659 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6660 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6661 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6662 server.
6663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006664 Supported in default-server: No
6665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006666track [<proxy>/]<server>
6667 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6668 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6669 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6670 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6671 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006673 Supported in default-server: No
6674
6675weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006676 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6677 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6678 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006679 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6680 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6681 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6682 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6683 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6684 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006686 Supported in default-server: Yes
6687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006688
66896. HTTP header manipulation
6690---------------------------
6691
6692In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6693response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6694request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6695which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6696against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6697to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6698passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6699headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6700never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6701
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006702There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6703(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6704rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6705messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6706in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006707happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006708add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6709normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006711This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6712in section 4.2 :
6713
6714 - reqadd <string>
6715 - reqallow <search>
6716 - reqiallow <search>
6717 - reqdel <search>
6718 - reqidel <search>
6719 - reqdeny <search>
6720 - reqideny <search>
6721 - reqpass <search>
6722 - reqipass <search>
6723 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6724 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6725 - reqtarpit <search>
6726 - reqitarpit <search>
6727 - rspadd <string>
6728 - rspdel <search>
6729 - rspidel <search>
6730 - rspdeny <search>
6731 - rspideny <search>
6732 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6733 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6734
6735With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6736is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6737parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6738prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6739Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6740
6741 \t for a tab
6742 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6743 \n for a new line (LF)
6744 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6745 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6746 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6747 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6748 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6749
6750The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6751portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6752above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6753regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
67549 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6755is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6756
6757The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6758after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6759
6760Notes related to these keywords :
6761---------------------------------
6762 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6763 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6764 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6765
6766 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6767 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6768 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6769
6770 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6771 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6772 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6773 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6774 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6775
6776 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6777 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6778 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6779 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6780 useless headers before adding new ones.
6781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006782 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006783 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6784
6785 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6786 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6787 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6788
6789 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6790 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006791 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006792
6793
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010067947. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6795------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006796
6797The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6798content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6799from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6800simple :
6801
6802 - define test criteria with sets of values
6803 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6804
6805The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6806
6807In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6808
6809 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6810
6811This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6812Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6813and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6814an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6815of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6816
6817ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6818'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6819which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6820
6821There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6822performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6823
6824The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6825
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006826 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6827 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006828 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6829
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006830The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6831specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6832possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006833multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6834be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6835needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6836space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6837match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6838lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6839duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6840to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6841instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006842
6843 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6844
6845In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6846the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6847case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6848too.
6849
6850Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6851a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6852ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006854Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006856 - integers or integer ranges
6857 - strings
6858 - regular expressions
6859 - IP addresses and networks
6860
6861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068627.1. Matching integers
6863----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006864
6865Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6866that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6867expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6868may be omitted.
6869
6870For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6871unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6872representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6873
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006874As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6875two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6876instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6877ranges and operators.
6878
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006879For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006880operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6881Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6882of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006884Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006885
6886 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6887 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6888 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6889 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6890 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006892For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006893
6894 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6895
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006896This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6897
6898 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069017.2. Matching strings
6902---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006903
6904String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6905exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6906characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6907string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6908to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006909before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006910
6911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069127.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6913-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006914
6915Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6916they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6917possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6918passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6919the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006920the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6921match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006922
6923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069247.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6925----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006926
6927IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6928netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6929within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006930host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006931difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6932at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6933does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6934parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006935
6936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069377.5. Available matching criteria
6938--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069407.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6941------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006942
6943A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6944analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6945addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6946
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006947always_false
6948 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6949 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6950
6951always_true
6952 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6953 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006955avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006956avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006957 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6958 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6959 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6960 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6961 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6962 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6963 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6964 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6965 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6966 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6967 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006968
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006969be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006970be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006971 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6972 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6973 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6974 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6975 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006976
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01006977be_id <integer>
6978 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
6979 backend it was called.
6980
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006981be_sess_rate <integer>
6982be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6983 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6984 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6985 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6986 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6987 sucking of an online dictionary).
6988
6989 Example :
6990 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6991 backend dynamic
6992 mode http
6993 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6994 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006995
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006996connslots <integer>
6997connslots(backend) <integer>
6998 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006999 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007000 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7001
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007002 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7003 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007004
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007005 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007006 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7007 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7008 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7009 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7010 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007011 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007012
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007013 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7014 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7015 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7016 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007017
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007018dst <ip_address>
7019 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7020 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007022dst_conn <integer>
7023 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7024 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7025 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7026 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7027 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7028 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7029
7030dst_port <integer>
7031 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7032 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7033
7034fe_conn <integer>
7035fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7036 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7037 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7038 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7039 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7040 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7041 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7042 criteria.
7043
7044fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007045 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007046 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007047
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007048fe_sess_rate <integer>
7049fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7050 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7051 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7052 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7053 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7054 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7055 the rate to go down below the limit.
7056
7057 Example :
7058 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7059 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7060 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7061 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7062 frontend mail
7063 bind :25
7064 mode tcp
7065 maxconn 100
7066 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7067 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7068 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7069 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007071nbsrv <integer>
7072nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7073 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7074 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7075 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7076 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7077 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007078
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007079queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007080queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007081 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7082 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7083 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7084 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7085 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7086 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7087 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007089sc1_bytes_in_rate
7090sc2_bytes_in_rate
7091 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7092 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7093 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7094
7095sc1_bytes_out_rate
7096sc2_bytes_out_rate
7097 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7098 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7099 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7100
7101sc1_conn_cnt
7102sc2_conn_cnt
7103 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7104 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7105
7106sc1_conn_cur
7107sc2_conn_cur
7108 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7109 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7110 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7111
7112sc1_conn_rate
7113sc2_conn_rate
7114 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7115 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7116 See also src_conn_rate.
7117
7118sc1_get_gpc0
7119sc2_get_gpc0
7120 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7121 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7122
7123sc1_http_err_cnt
7124sc2_http_err_cnt
7125 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7126 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7127 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7128
7129sc1_http_err_rate
7130sc2_http_err_rate
7131 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7132 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7133 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7134 src_http_err_rate.
7135
7136sc1_http_req_cnt
7137sc2_http_req_cnt
7138 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7139 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7140 src_http_req_cnt.
7141
7142sc1_http_req_rate
7143sc2_http_req_rate
7144 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7145 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7146 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7147 src_http_req_rate.
7148
7149sc1_inc_gpc0
7150sc2_inc_gpc0
7151 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7152 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7153 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7154 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7155 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7156 when a first ACL was verified :
7157
7158 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7159 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7160 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7161
7162sc1_kbytes_in
7163sc2_kbytes_in
7164 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7165 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7166 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7167 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7168
7169sc1_kbytes_out
7170sc2_kbytes_out
7171 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7172 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7173 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7174 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7175
7176sc1_sess_cnt
7177sc2_sess_cnt
7178 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7179 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7180 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7181 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7182 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7183 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7184
7185sc1_sess_rate
7186sc2_sess_rate
7187 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7188 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7189 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7190 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7191 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7192 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007194so_id <integer>
7195 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7196
7197src <ip_address>
7198 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7199 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7200 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7201
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007202src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7203src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7204 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7205 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7206 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007207 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007208
7209src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7210src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7211 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7212 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7213 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007214 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007215
7216src_conn_cnt <integer>
7217src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7218 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7219 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7220 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007221 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007222
7223src_conn_cur <integer>
7224src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7225 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7226 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7227 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007228 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007229
7230src_conn_rate <integer>
7231src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7232 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7233 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7234 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007235 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007236
7237src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7238src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7239 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7240 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7241 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007242 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007243
7244src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7245src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7246 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7247 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7248 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007249 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007250
7251src_http_err_rate <integer>
7252src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7253 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7254 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7255 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7256 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007257 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007258
7259src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7260src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7261 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7262 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7263 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007264 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007265
7266src_http_req_rate <integer>
7267src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7268 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7269 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7270 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7271 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007272 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007273
7274src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7275src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7276 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7277 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7278 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7279 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7280 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7281 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7282
7283 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7284 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007285 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007286
7287src_kbytes_in <integer>
7288src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7289 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7290 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7291 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7292 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007293 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007294
7295src_kbytes_out <integer>
7296src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7297 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7298 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7299 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7300 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007301 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007302
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007303src_port <integer>
7304 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007305
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007306src_sess_cnt <integer>
7307src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7308 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7309 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7310 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7311 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007312 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007313
7314src_sess_rate <integer>
7315src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7316 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7317 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7318 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7319 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007320 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007321
7322src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7323src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007324 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007325 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7326 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007327 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7328 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7329 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007330 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007331
7332 Example :
7333 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7334 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7335 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7336 listen ssh
7337 bind :22
7338 mode tcp
7339 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007340 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007341 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7342 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7343
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007344srv_id <integer>
7345 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7346
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007347srv_is_up(<server>)
7348srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7349 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7350 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7351 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7352 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7353 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7354 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7355 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7356 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007358
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020073597.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7360---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007361
7362A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7363during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007364through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7365keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007366
7367req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007368 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007369 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7370 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7371 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7372 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7373 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7374 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7375
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007376req_proto_http
7377 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7378 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007379 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007380 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7381 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7382
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007383req_rdp_cookie <string>
7384req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7385 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7386 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7387 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7388 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7389 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7390 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7391 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7392 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7393
7394req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7395req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7396 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7397 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7398 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7399 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7400 cookies.
7401
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007402req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7403 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7404 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7405 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7406 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7407 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7408 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7409 with TCP request content inspection.
7410
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007411req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7412 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7413 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7414 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7415 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7416
7417rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7418 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7419 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7420 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7421 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7422
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007423wait_end
7424 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7425 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7426 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7427 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7428 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7429 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7430 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7431 inspection.
7432
7433 Examples :
7434 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7435 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7436 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7437
7438 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7439 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7440 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7441 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7442 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7443 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7444 tcp-request content reject
7445
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074477.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7448--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007449
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007450A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007451application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7452read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7453than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7454
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007455hdr <string>
7456hdr(header) <string>
7457 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7458 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7459 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7460 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7461 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7462
7463 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7464 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7465 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7466
7467 hdr(Connection) -i close
7468
7469hdr_beg <string>
7470hdr_beg(header) <string>
7471 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7472 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7473 response headers sent by the server.
7474
7475hdr_cnt <integer>
7476hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7477 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7478 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7479 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7480 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7481 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7482 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7483 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7484
7485hdr_dir <string>
7486hdr_dir(header) <string>
7487 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7488 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7489 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7490 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7491 headers sent by the server.
7492
7493hdr_dom <string>
7494hdr_dom(header) <string>
7495 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7496 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7497 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7498 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7499 server.
7500
7501hdr_end <string>
7502hdr_end(header) <string>
7503 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7504 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7505 response headers sent by the server.
7506
7507hdr_ip <ip_address>
7508hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7509 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7510 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7511 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7512 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7513
7514hdr_reg <regex>
7515hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7516 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7517 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7518 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7519 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7520 response headers sent by the server.
7521
7522hdr_sub <string>
7523hdr_sub(header) <string>
7524 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7525 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7526 response headers sent by the server.
7527
7528hdr_val <integer>
7529hdr_val(header) <integer>
7530 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7531 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7532 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7533 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7534
7535http_auth(userlist)
7536http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7537 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7538 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7539 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7540 of specified groups.
7541
7542 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7543
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007544http_req_first
7545 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7546 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7547 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7548 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007550method <string>
7551 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7552 already check for most common methods.
7553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007554path <string>
7555 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7556 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7557 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7558
7559path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007560 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7561 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007562
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007563path_dir <string>
7564 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7565 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7566 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7567 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7568
7569path_dom <string>
7570 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7571 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7572 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7573
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007574path_end <string>
7575 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7576 control file name extension.
7577
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007578path_reg <regex>
7579 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7580 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7581 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7582
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007583path_sub <string>
7584 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7585 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7586 "path_dir".
7587
7588req_ver <string>
7589 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7590 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7591
7592status <integer>
7593 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7594 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7595 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007597url <string>
7598 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7599 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7600
7601url_beg <string>
7602 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7603 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007605url_dir <string>
7606 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7607 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7608 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7609 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7610
7611url_dom <string>
7612 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7613 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7614 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7615
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007616url_end <string>
7617 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7618 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007619
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007620url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007621 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7622 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007623 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007624
7625url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007626 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7627 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007628 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007629 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007630
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007631url_reg <regex>
7632 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7633 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7634 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007635
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007636url_sub <string>
7637 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7638 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007639
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076417.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7642---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007644Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7645every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007646order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007648ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7649---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007650FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007651HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007652HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7653HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007654HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7655HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7656HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7657HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7658LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007659METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7660METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7661METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7662METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7663METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7664METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007665RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007666REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007667TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007668WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7669---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007670
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7673----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007675Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7676combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007678 - AND (implicit)
7679 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7680 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007682A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007684 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007686Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7687indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007689For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7690"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7691requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7692is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007694 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7695 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7696 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7697 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007699To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7700and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007702 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7703 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7704 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7705 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007707 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7708 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7709 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7710 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007711
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007712It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7713expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7714be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7715the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7716
7717 The following rule :
7718
7719 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7720 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7721
7722 Can also be written that way :
7723
7724 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7725
7726It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7727to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7728simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7729sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7730good use is the following :
7731
7732 With named ACLs :
7733
7734 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7735 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7736 monitor fail if site_dead
7737
7738 With anonymous ACLs :
7739
7740 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007742See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007743
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007744
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077457.8. Pattern extraction
7746-----------------------
7747
7748The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7749response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7750for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7751
7752All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7753"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7754begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7755arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7756much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7757equivalent used in ACLs.
7758
7759The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7760
7761 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7762 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7763
7764 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7765 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7766 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7767 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7768
7769 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7770 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7771 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7772 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7773 type integer and only works with such tables.
7774
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007775 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7776 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7777 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7778 x-forwarded-for header.
7779
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007780 payload(offset,length)
7781 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7782 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7783 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7784 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007785
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007786 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7787 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7788 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7789 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7790 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7791 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7792 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7793 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7794 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7795
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007796The currently available list of transformations include :
7797
7798 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7799 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7800 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7801
7802 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7803 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7804 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7805
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007806 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7807 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7808 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7809 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7810 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7811
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078138. Logging
7814----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007816One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7817provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7818very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7819provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7820state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007821to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007822headers.
7823
7824In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7825about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7826send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7827
7828 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7829 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7830 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7831 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7832 at the termination.
7833
7834The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7835allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7836as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7837while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7838real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7839delay.
7840
7841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078428.1. Log levels
7843---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007844
7845TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7846source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7847HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7848in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7849particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007850syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007851facilities.
7852
7853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078548.2. Log formats
7855----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007856
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007857HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007858and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7859the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7860formats are the following ones :
7861
7862 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7863 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7864 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7865 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7866 extents.
7867
7868 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7869 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7870 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7871 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7872 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7873
7874 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7875 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7876 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7877 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7878 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7879
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007880 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7881 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7882 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7883 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7884
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007885Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7886specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7887field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7888servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7889always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7890identifier.
7891
7892Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7893 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7894 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7895 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7896 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7897
7898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078998.2.1. Default log format
7900-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007901
7902This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7903as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7904format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7905
7906 Example :
7907 listen www
7908 mode http
7909 log global
7910 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7911
7912 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7913 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7914 (www/HTTP)
7915
7916 Field Format Extract from the example above
7917 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7918 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7919 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7920 4 'to' to
7921 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7922 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7923
7924Detailed fields description :
7925 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7926 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7927 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7928 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7929 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7930 and processed the connection.
7931 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7932
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007933In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
7934"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
7935connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
7936
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007937It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7938will eventually disappear.
7939
7940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079418.2.2. TCP log format
7942---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007943
7944The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7945is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7946information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7947counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7948emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7949environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7950the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7951sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007952specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7953not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7954fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7955marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007956
7957 Example :
7958 frontend fnt
7959 mode tcp
7960 option tcplog
7961 log global
7962 default_backend bck
7963
7964 backend bck
7965 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7966
7967 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7968 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7969 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7970
7971 Field Format Extract from the example above
7972 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7973 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7974 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7975 4 frontend_name fnt
7976 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7977 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7978 7 bytes_read* 212
7979 8 termination_state --
7980 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7981 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7982
7983Detailed fields description :
7984 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007985 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
7986 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
7987 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
7988 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
7989 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007990
7991 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007992 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
7993 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
7994 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007995
7996 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7997 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7998 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7999 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8000
8001 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8002 and processed the connection.
8003
8004 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8005 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8006 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8007 applications.
8008
8009 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8010 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8011 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8012 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8013 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8014
8015 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8016 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8017 See "Timers" below for more details.
8018
8019 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8020 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8021 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8022 "Timers" below for more details.
8023
8024 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8025 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8026 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8027 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8028 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8029 details.
8030
8031 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8032 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8033 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8034 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8035 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8036
8037 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8038 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8039 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8040 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8041 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8042 for more details.
8043
8044 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8045 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8046 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8047 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8048 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008049 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008050
8051 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8052 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8053 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8054 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8055 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8056 caused by a denial of service attack.
8057
8058 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8059 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8060 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8061 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8062 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8063 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8064 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8065 denial of service attack.
8066
8067 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8068 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8069 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8070 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8071 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8072 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8073 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8074 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8075 be processed than on other servers.
8076
8077 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8078 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8079 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8080 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8081 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8082 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8083 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8084 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8085 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8086 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8087 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8088 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8089 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8090
8091 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8092 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8093 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8094 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8095 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8096 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8097 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8098 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8099
8100 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8101 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8102 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8103 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8104 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8105 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8106 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8107 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8108 occurs.
8109
8110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081118.2.3. HTTP log format
8112----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008113
8114The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8115is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8116the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8117are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8118emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8119generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8120"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8121which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008122frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8123is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008124
8125Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8126slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8127with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8128
8129 Example :
8130 frontend http-in
8131 mode http
8132 option httplog
8133 log global
8134 default_backend bck
8135
8136 backend static
8137 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8138
8139 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8140 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8141 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008142 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008143
8144 Field Format Extract from the example above
8145 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8146 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8147 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8148 4 frontend_name http-in
8149 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8150 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8151 7 status_code 200
8152 8 bytes_read* 2750
8153 9 captured_request_cookie -
8154 10 captured_response_cookie -
8155 11 termination_state ----
8156 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8157 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8158 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8159 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8160 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008161
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008162
8163Detailed fields description :
8164 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008165 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8166 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8167 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8168 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8169 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008170
8171 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008172 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8173 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8174 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008175
8176 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8177 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8178 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8179 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8180 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8181
8182 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8183 and processed the connection.
8184
8185 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8186 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8187 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8188
8189 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8190 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8191 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8192 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8193 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8194 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8195
8196 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8197 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8198 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8199 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8200 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8201 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8202
8203 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8204 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8205 See "Timers" below for more details.
8206
8207 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8208 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8209 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8210 below for more details.
8211
8212 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8213 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8214 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8215 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8216 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8217 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8218 for more details.
8219
8220 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8221 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8222 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8223 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8224 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8225 details.
8226
8227 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8228 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8229 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8230
8231 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8232 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8233 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8234 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8235 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8236 overflowing.
8237
8238 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8239 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8240 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8241 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8242 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8243 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8244 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8245 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8246
8247 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8248 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8249 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8250 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8251 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8252 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8253 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8254 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8255
8256 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8257 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8258 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8259 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8260 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8261 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8262 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8263
8264 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8265 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8266 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8267 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8268 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008269 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008270 system.
8271
8272 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8273 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8274 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8275 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8276 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8277 caused by a denial of service attack.
8278
8279 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8280 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8281 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8282 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8283 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8284 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8285 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8286 denial of service attack.
8287
8288 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8289 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8290 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8291 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8292 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8293 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8294 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8295 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8296 processed than on other servers.
8297
8298 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8299 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8300 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8301 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8302 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8303 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8304 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8305 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8306 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8307 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8308 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8309 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8310 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8311
8312 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8313 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8314 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8315 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8316 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8317 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8318 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8319 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8320
8321 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8322 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8323 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8324 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8325 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8326 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8327 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8328 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8329 occurs.
8330
8331 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8332 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8333 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8334 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8335 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8336 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8337 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8338 cookies" below for more details.
8339
8340 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8341 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8342 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8343 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8344 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8345 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8346 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8347 and cookies" below for more details.
8348
8349 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8350 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8351 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8352 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8353 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8354 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8355 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8356 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8357
8358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083598.3. Advanced logging options
8360-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008361
8362Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8363just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8364options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8365for more information about their usage.
8366
8367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083688.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8369------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008370
8371It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8372haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8373commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8374monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8375ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8376
8377 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8378 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8379 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8380 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8381
8382 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8383 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8384 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8385 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8386 such as other load-balancers.
8387
8388 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8389 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8390 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8391
8392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083938.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8394----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008395
8396The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8397what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8398or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8399"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8400just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8401log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8402after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8403is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8404with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8405with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8406
8407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8409------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008410
8411Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8412for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8413"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8414retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8415raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8416a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8417file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8418you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8419"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8420
8421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084228.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8423--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008424
8425Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8426multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8427them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8428"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8429logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8430error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8431and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8432too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8433useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8434alternative.
8435
8436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084378.4. Timing events
8438------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008439
8440Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8441reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8442the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8443frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8444mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8445
8446 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8447 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8448 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8449 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8450 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8451
8452 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8453 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8454 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8455 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8456 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8457
8458 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8459 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8460 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8461 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8462 connection never established.
8463
8464 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8465 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8466 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8467 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8468 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8469 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8470 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8471 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8472 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8473 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8474 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8475
8476 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8477 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8478 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8479 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8480 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8481
8482 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8483
8484 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8485 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8486 negative.
8487
8488These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8489protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8490that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008491due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008492close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8493session has been aborted on timeout.
8494
8495Most common cases :
8496
8497 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8498 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8499 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8500 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8501 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8502 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8503 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8504 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8505 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008506 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8507 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8508 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008509
8510 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8511 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8512 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8513 of ms on remote networks.
8514
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008515 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8516 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8517 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008518
8519 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8520 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8521 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8522 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8523 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8524 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8525 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8526 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8527 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8528 to the server until another one is released.
8529
8530Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8531
8532 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8533 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8534 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8535
8536 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8537 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8538 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8539
8540 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8541 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8542 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8543 flags.
8544
8545 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8546 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8547 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8548 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8549 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8550 the client connection was maintained open.
8551
8552 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8553 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8554 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8555 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8556
8557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085588.5. Session state at disconnection
8559-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008560
8561TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8562"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
85632-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8564each of which has a special meaning :
8565
8566 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8567 session to terminate :
8568
8569 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8570
8571 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8572 server explicitly refused it.
8573
8574 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8575 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8576 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8577 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8578 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8579 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8580
8581 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8582 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8583 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8584 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8585 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8586
8587 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8588 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8589 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8590 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8591 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8592
8593 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8594 send or receive data.
8595
8596 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8597 send or receive data.
8598
8599 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8600 with nothing left in the buffers.
8601
8602 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8603
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008604 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008605 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8606
8607 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8608 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8609 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8610 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8611 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8612
8613 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8614 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8615
8616 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8617 server (HTTP only).
8618
8619 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8620
8621 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8622 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8623 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8624
8625 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8626 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8627 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8628
8629 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8630
8631 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8632 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8633
8634 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8635 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8636 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8637
8638 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8639 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008640 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8641 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008642
8643 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8644 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8645 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8646 another server.
8647
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008648 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008649 server.
8650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008651 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8652 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8653 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8654 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8655
8656 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8657 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8658 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8659 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8660
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008661 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8662
8663 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8664 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8665
8666 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8667
8668 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8669 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8670 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8671
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008672 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8673 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8674 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8675 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8676 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8677
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008678 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8679
8680 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8681 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8682
8683 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8684
8685 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8686
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008687The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8688was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008689helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8690starvation, attacks, etc...
8691
8692The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8693alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8694easier finding and understanding.
8695
8696 Flags Reason
8697
8698 -- Normal termination.
8699
8700 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8701 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8702 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8703 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8704
8705 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8706 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8707 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8708 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8709 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8710 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008711
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008712 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8713 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8714 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8715
8716 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8717 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8718 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8719
8720 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8721 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8722 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8723 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8724 the server takes too long to respond.
8725
8726 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8727 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8728 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8729 long a time to respond.
8730
8731 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8732 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8733 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8734 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8735 and the client.
8736
8737 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8738 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8739 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8740 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8741 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8742 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8743
8744 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8745 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008746 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8747 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8748 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8749 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008751 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008752 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8753 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8754 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8755 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8756 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8757
8758 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8759 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8760 503 or 504 here.
8761
8762 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8763 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8764 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8765 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8766 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8767
8768 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8769 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008770 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008771 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8772 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8773
8774 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8775 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8776 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8777 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8778 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8779 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8780 between haproxy and the server.
8781
8782 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8783 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8784 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8785 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8786 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8787 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8788 solution is to fix the application.
8789
8790 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8791 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8792 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8793 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8794 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8795 external attacks.
8796
8797 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8798 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8799 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8800 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8801 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8802
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008803 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8804 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8805 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8806 the client.
8807
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008808 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8809 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8810 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8811 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008812 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8813 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8814 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8815 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8816 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008817
8818 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8819 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8820 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8821 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8822
8823 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8824 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8825 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8826 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8827
8828 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8829 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8830 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8831 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8832
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008833The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8834persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8835important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8836re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8837
8838 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8839
8840 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8841 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8842 set on a GET request.
8843
8844 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8845 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8846 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8847 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8848
8849 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8850 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8851 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8852
8853 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8854 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8855 already got a cookie.
8856
8857 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8858 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8859 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8860 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8861 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8862
8863 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8864 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8865 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8866
8867 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8868 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8869 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8870
8871 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8872 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8873
8874 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8875 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8876 then advertised in the response.
8877
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088798.6. Non-printable characters
8880-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008881
8882In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8883consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8884converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8885prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8886being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8887escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8888is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8889'}' when logging headers.
8890
8891Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8892issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8893containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8894
8895Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8896the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8897performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8898
8899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8901---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008902
8903Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8904achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008905section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008906cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8907the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8908the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008909locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008910not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8911user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8912a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8913wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8914
8915 Examples :
8916 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8917 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8918
8919 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8920 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8921
8922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8924---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008925
8926Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8927proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8928the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8929server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8930
8931Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8932response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008933section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008934
8935It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008936time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8937appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008938are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8939and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8940follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8941request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8942in the logs.
8943
8944 Example :
8945 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8946 listen proxy-out
8947 mode http
8948 option httplog
8949 option logasap
8950 log global
8951 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8952
8953 # log the name of the virtual server
8954 capture request header Host len 20
8955
8956 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8957 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8958
8959 # log the beginning of the referrer
8960 capture request header Referer len 20
8961
8962 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8963 capture response header Server len 20
8964
8965 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8966 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8967
8968 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8969 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8970
8971 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8972 capture response header Via len 20
8973
8974 # log the URL location during a redirection
8975 capture response header Location len 20
8976
8977 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8978 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8979 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8980 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8981 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8982
8983 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8984 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8985 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8986 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008987 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008988
8989 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8990 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8991 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8992 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8993 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008994 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008995
8996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089978.9. Examples of logs
8998---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008999
9000These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9001them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9002reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9003
9004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9005 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9006 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9007
9008 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9009 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9010
9011 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9012 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9013 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9014
9015 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9016 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9017
9018 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9019 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9020 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9021
9022 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009023 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009024 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9025 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9026
9027 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9028 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9029 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9030
9031 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9032 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9033 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9034 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9035 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9036 to return the 502 and not the server.
9037
9038 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009039 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009040
9041 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9042 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9043 Nothing was sent to any server.
9044
9045 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9046 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9047
9048 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9049 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9050 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9051 send a 408 return code to the client.
9052
9053 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9054 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9055
9056 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9057 5 seconds ("c----").
9058
9059 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9060 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009061 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009062
9063 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009064 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009065 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9066 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9067 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9068 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9069 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009070
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090729. Statistics and monitoring
9073----------------------------
9074
9075It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9076mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9077CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9078Unix socket.
9079
9080
90819.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009082---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009083
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009084The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9085page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009087 0. pxname: proxy name
9088 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9089 for server)
9090 2. qcur: current queued requests
9091 3. qmax: max queued requests
9092 4. scur: current sessions
9093 5. smax: max sessions
9094 6. slim: sessions limit
9095 7. stot: total sessions
9096 8. bin: bytes in
9097 9. bout: bytes out
9098 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009099 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009100 12. ereq: request errors
9101 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009102 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009103 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9104 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009105 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009106 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9107 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9108 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9109 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9110 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9111 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9112 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9113 25. qlimit: queue limit
9114 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9115 27. iid: unique proxy id
9116 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9117 29. throttle: warm up status
9118 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9119 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009120 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009121 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9122 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9123 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009124 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009125 UNK -> unknown
9126 INI -> initializing
9127 SOCKERR -> socket error
9128 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9129 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9130 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9131 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9132 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9133 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9134 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9135 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9136 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9137 disable-on-404
9138 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9139 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9140 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009141 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9142 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009143 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9144 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9145 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9146 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9147 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9148 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009149 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9150 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9151 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9152 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009153 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9154 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009155
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091579.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009158-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009159
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009160The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009161must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9162is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9163a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9164risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9165followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9166given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9167then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9168to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009169
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009170It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9171on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9172own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009174clear counters
9175 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9176 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9177 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9178 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9179 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9180
9181clear counters all
9182 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9183 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9184 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9185
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009186clear table <table> key <key>
9187 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9188 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9189 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9190 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9191 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9192 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9193 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9194 usuall enough.
9195
9196 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009197 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009198 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009199 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9200 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9201 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9202 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009203
9204 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9205
9206 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009207 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009208 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9209 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009210
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009211disable server <backend>/<server>
9212 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9213 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9214 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9215 during the maintenance.
9216
9217 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9218 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9219
9220 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9221 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9222
9223 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9224 level "admin".
9225
9226enable server <backend>/<server>
9227 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9228 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9229
9230 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9231 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9232
9233 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9234 level "admin".
9235
9236get weight <backend>/<server>
9237 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9238 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9239 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9240 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9241 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9242 dash ('#').
9243
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009244help
9245 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9246 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009247
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009248prompt
9249 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9250 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9251 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9252 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9253 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9254 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9255 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9256 command.
9257
9258quit
9259 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009260
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009261set timeout cli <delay>
9262 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9263 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9264 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9265
9266set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9267 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9268 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9269 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9270 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9271 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9272 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9273 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9274 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9275 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9276 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9277 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9278 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9279 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9280 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9281
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009282show errors [<iid>]
9283 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9284 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009285 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9286 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9287 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009288
9289 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9290 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9291 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9292 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9293 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9294 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9295 are reported too.
9296
9297 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9298 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9299 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9300 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9301 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9302 code.
9303
9304 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9305 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9306 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9307 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9308 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9309 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9310 line.
9311
9312 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009313 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9314 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009315 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9316 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9317
9318 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9319 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9320 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9321 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9322 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9323 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9324 00204+ minal\r\n
9325 00211 \r\n
9326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009327 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009328 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9329 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9330 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9331 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9332 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9333 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009334
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009335show info
9336 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9337
9338show sess
9339 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009340 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9341 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9342
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009343show sess <id>
9344 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9345 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9346 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9347 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9348 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9349 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009350
9351show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9352 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9353 possible to dump only selected items :
9354 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9355 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9356 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9357 for example:
9358 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9359 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9360 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9361
9362 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009363 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9364 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009365 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9366 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9367 Nbproc: 1
9368 Process_num: 1
9369 (...)
9370
9371 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9372 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9373 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9374 (...)
9375 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9376
9377 $
9378
9379 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9380 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9381 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9382 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009383 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009384
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009385show table
9386 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9387 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9388 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9389 entries currently in use.
9390
9391 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009392 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9393 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9394 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009395
9396show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9397 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9398 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9399 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9400 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9401 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9402 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9403 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9404 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9405 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9406 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9407 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9408 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9409 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9410 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9411
9412 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009413 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9414 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9415 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9416 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9417 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9418 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009419
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009420 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9421 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9422 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9423 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009424
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009425 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9426 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9427 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9428 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9429 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009430
9431 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9432 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9433 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9434 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9435 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9436
9437 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9438 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9439 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009440 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9441 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009442 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9443 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009444
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009445/*
9446 * Local variables:
9447 * fill-column: 79
9448 * End:
9449 */